1 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 // Name: src/richtext/richtextbuffer.cpp
3 // Purpose: Buffer for wxRichTextCtrl
4 // Author: Julian Smart
7 // Copyright: (c) Julian Smart
8 // Licence: wxWindows licence
9 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11 // For compilers that support precompilation, includes "wx.h".
12 #include "wx/wxprec.h"
20 #include "wx/richtext/richtextbuffer.h"
26 #include "wx/dataobj.h"
27 #include "wx/module.h"
30 #include "wx/settings.h"
31 #include "wx/filename.h"
32 #include "wx/clipbrd.h"
33 #include "wx/wfstream.h"
34 #include "wx/mstream.h"
35 #include "wx/sstream.h"
36 #include "wx/textfile.h"
37 #include "wx/hashmap.h"
38 #include "wx/dynarray.h"
40 #include "wx/richtext/richtextctrl.h"
41 #include "wx/richtext/richtextstyles.h"
42 #include "wx/richtext/richtextimagedlg.h"
43 #include "wx/richtext/richtextsizepage.h"
44 #include "wx/richtext/richtextxml.h"
46 #include "wx/listimpl.cpp"
47 #include "wx/arrimpl.cpp"
49 WX_DEFINE_LIST(wxRichTextObjectList
)
50 WX_DEFINE_LIST(wxRichTextLineList
)
52 // Switch off if the platform doesn't like it for some reason
53 #define wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING 1
55 // Use GetPartialTextExtents for platforms that support it natively
56 #define wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS 1
58 const wxChar wxRichTextLineBreakChar
= (wxChar
) 29;
60 // Helper classes for floating layout
61 struct wxRichTextFloatRectMap
63 wxRichTextFloatRectMap(int sY
, int eY
, int w
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
73 wxRichTextObject
* anchor
;
76 WX_DEFINE_SORTED_ARRAY(wxRichTextFloatRectMap
*, wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
);
78 int wxRichTextFloatRectMapCmp(wxRichTextFloatRectMap
* r1
, wxRichTextFloatRectMap
* r2
)
80 return r1
->startY
- r2
->startY
;
83 class wxRichTextFloatCollector
86 wxRichTextFloatCollector(const wxRect
& availableRect
);
87 ~wxRichTextFloatCollector();
89 // Collect the floating objects info in the given paragraph
90 void CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
);
91 void CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
, wxRichTextObject
* floating
);
93 // Return the last paragraph we collected
94 wxRichTextParagraph
* LastParagraph();
96 // Given the start y position and the height of the line,
97 // find out how wide the line can be
98 wxRect
GetAvailableRect(int startY
, int endY
);
100 // Given a floating box, find its fit position
101 int GetFitPosition(int direction
, int start
, int height
) const;
102 int GetFitPosition(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int start
, int height
) const;
104 // Find the last y position
105 int GetLastRectBottom();
107 // Draw the floats inside a rect
108 void Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
);
110 // HitTest the floats
111 int HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int flags
);
113 // Get floating object count
114 int GetFloatingObjectCount() const { return m_left
.GetCount() + m_right
.GetCount(); }
116 // Get floating objects
117 bool GetFloatingObjects(wxRichTextObjectList
& objects
) const;
120 bool DeleteFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
);
122 // Do we have this float already?
123 bool HasFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
);
125 bool HasFloats() const { return m_left
.GetCount() >0 || m_right
.GetCount() > 0; }
127 static int SearchAdjacentRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int point
);
129 static int GetWidthFromFloatRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int index
, int startY
, int endY
);
131 static void FreeFloatRectMapArray(wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
);
133 static void DrawFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
);
135 static int HitTestFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int flags
);
138 wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray m_left
;
139 wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray m_right
;
141 wxRect m_availableRect
;
142 wxRichTextParagraph
* m_para
;
146 bool wxRichTextFloatCollector::DeleteFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
149 for (i
= 0; i
< m_left
.GetCount(); i
++)
151 if (m_left
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
157 for (i
= 0; i
< m_right
.GetCount(); i
++)
159 if (m_right
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
168 // Do we have this float already?
169 bool wxRichTextFloatCollector::HasFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
172 for (i
= 0; i
< m_left
.GetCount(); i
++)
174 if (m_left
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
179 for (i
= 0; i
< m_right
.GetCount(); i
++)
181 if (m_right
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
189 // Get floating objects
190 bool wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetFloatingObjects(wxRichTextObjectList
& objects
) const
193 for (i
= 0; i
< m_left
.GetCount(); i
++)
194 objects
.Append(m_left
[i
]->anchor
);
195 for (i
= 0; i
< m_right
.GetCount(); i
++)
196 objects
.Append(m_right
[i
]->anchor
);
202 * Binary search helper function
203 * The argument point is the Y coordinate, and this fuction
204 * always return the floating rect that contain this coordinate
205 * or under this coordinate.
207 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::SearchAdjacentRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int point
)
209 int end
= array
.GetCount() - 1;
222 int mid
= (start
+ end
) / 2;
223 if (array
[mid
]->startY
<= point
&& array
[mid
]->endY
>= point
)
225 else if (array
[mid
]->startY
> point
)
230 else if (array
[mid
]->endY
< point
)
240 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetWidthFromFloatRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int index
, int startY
, int endY
)
243 int len
= array
.GetCount();
245 wxASSERT(index
>= 0 && index
< len
);
247 if (array
[index
]->startY
< startY
&& array
[index
]->endY
> startY
)
248 ret
= ret
< array
[index
]->width
? array
[index
]->width
: ret
;
249 while (index
< len
&& array
[index
]->startY
<= endY
)
251 ret
= ret
< array
[index
]->width
? array
[index
]->width
: ret
;
258 wxRichTextFloatCollector::wxRichTextFloatCollector(const wxRect
& rect
) : m_left(wxRichTextFloatRectMapCmp
), m_right(wxRichTextFloatRectMapCmp
)
260 m_availableRect
= rect
;
264 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::FreeFloatRectMapArray(wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
)
266 int len
= array
.GetCount();
267 for (int i
= 0; i
< len
; i
++)
271 wxRichTextFloatCollector::~wxRichTextFloatCollector()
273 FreeFloatRectMapArray(m_left
);
274 FreeFloatRectMapArray(m_right
);
277 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetFitPosition(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int start
, int height
) const
279 if (array
.GetCount() == 0)
282 int i
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, start
);
284 while (i
< (int) array
.GetCount())
286 if (array
[i
]->startY
- last
>= height
)
288 last
= array
[i
]->endY
;
295 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetFitPosition(int direction
, int start
, int height
) const
297 if (direction
== wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_LEFT
)
298 return GetFitPosition(m_left
, start
, height
);
299 else if (direction
== wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_RIGHT
)
300 return GetFitPosition(m_right
, start
, height
);
303 wxASSERT("Never should be here");
308 // Adds a floating image to the float collector.
309 // The actual positioning is done by wxRichTextParagraph::LayoutFloat.
310 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
, wxRichTextObject
* floating
)
312 int direction
= floating
->GetFloatDirection();
314 wxPoint pos
= floating
->GetPosition();
315 wxSize size
= floating
->GetCachedSize();
316 wxRichTextFloatRectMap
*map
= new wxRichTextFloatRectMap(pos
.y
, pos
.y
+ size
.y
, size
.x
, floating
);
319 case wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_NONE
:
322 case wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_LEFT
:
323 // Just a not-enough simple assertion
324 wxASSERT (m_left
.Index(map
) == wxNOT_FOUND
);
327 case wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_RIGHT
:
328 wxASSERT (m_right
.Index(map
) == wxNOT_FOUND
);
333 wxASSERT("Unrecognised float attribute.");
339 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
)
341 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
344 wxRichTextObject
* floating
= node
->GetData();
346 if (floating
->IsFloating())
348 CollectFloat(para
, floating
);
351 node
= node
->GetNext();
357 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextFloatCollector::LastParagraph()
362 wxRect
wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetAvailableRect(int startY
, int endY
)
364 int widthLeft
= 0, widthRight
= 0;
365 if (m_left
.GetCount() != 0)
367 int i
= SearchAdjacentRect(m_left
, startY
);
368 if (i
< (int) m_left
.GetCount())
369 widthLeft
= GetWidthFromFloatRect(m_left
, i
, startY
, endY
);
371 if (m_right
.GetCount() != 0)
373 int j
= SearchAdjacentRect(m_right
, startY
);
374 if (j
< (int) m_right
.GetCount())
375 widthRight
= GetWidthFromFloatRect(m_right
, j
, startY
, endY
);
378 // TODO: actually we want to use the actual image positions to find the
379 // available remaining space, since the image might not be right up against
380 // the left or right edge of the container.
381 return wxRect(widthLeft
+ m_availableRect
.x
, 0, m_availableRect
.width
- widthLeft
- widthRight
, 0);
384 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetLastRectBottom()
387 int len
= m_left
.GetCount();
389 ret
= ret
> m_left
[len
-1]->endY
? ret
: m_left
[len
-1]->endY
;
391 len
= m_right
.GetCount();
393 ret
= ret
> m_right
[len
-1]->endY
? ret
: m_right
[len
-1]->endY
;
399 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::DrawFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& WXUNUSED(range
), const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
402 int end
= rect
.y
+ rect
.height
;
404 i
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, start
);
405 if (i
< 0 || i
>= (int) array
.GetCount())
407 j
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, end
);
408 if (j
< 0 || j
>= (int) array
.GetCount())
409 j
= array
.GetCount() - 1;
412 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= array
[i
]->anchor
;
413 wxRichTextRange r
= obj
->GetRange();
414 obj
->Draw(dc
, context
, r
, selection
, wxRect(obj
->GetPosition(), obj
->GetCachedSize()), descent
, style
);
419 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
421 if (m_left
.GetCount() > 0)
422 DrawFloat(m_left
, dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
423 if (m_right
.GetCount() > 0)
424 DrawFloat(m_right
, dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
427 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::HitTestFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& WXUNUSED(dc
), wxRichTextDrawingContext
& WXUNUSED(context
), const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
430 if (array
.GetCount() == 0)
431 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
432 i
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, pt
.y
);
433 if (i
< 0 || i
>= (int) array
.GetCount())
434 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
435 if (!array
[i
]->anchor
->IsShown())
436 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
438 wxPoint point
= array
[i
]->anchor
->GetPosition();
439 wxSize size
= array
[i
]->anchor
->GetCachedSize();
440 if (point
.x
<= pt
.x
&& point
.x
+ size
.x
>= pt
.x
441 && point
.y
<= pt
.y
&& point
.y
+ size
.y
>= pt
.y
)
443 textPosition
= array
[i
]->anchor
->GetRange().GetStart();
444 * obj
= array
[i
]->anchor
;
445 if (pt
.x
> (pt
.x
+ pt
.x
+ size
.x
) / 2)
446 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
;
448 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
;
451 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
454 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int flags
)
456 int ret
= HitTestFloat(m_left
, dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, flags
);
457 if (ret
== wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
459 ret
= HitTestFloat(m_right
, dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, flags
);
464 // Helpers for efficiency
465 inline void wxCheckSetFont(wxDC
& dc
, const wxFont
& font
)
470 inline void wxCheckSetPen(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPen
& pen
)
472 const wxPen
& pen1
= dc
.GetPen();
473 if (pen1
.IsOk() && pen
.IsOk())
475 if (pen1
.GetWidth() == pen
.GetWidth() &&
476 pen1
.GetStyle() == pen
.GetStyle() &&
477 pen1
.GetColour() == pen
.GetColour())
483 inline void wxCheckSetBrush(wxDC
& dc
, const wxBrush
& brush
)
485 const wxBrush
& brush1
= dc
.GetBrush();
486 if (brush1
.IsOk() && brush
.IsOk())
488 if (brush1
.GetStyle() == brush
.GetStyle() &&
489 brush1
.GetColour() == brush
.GetColour())
497 * This is the base for drawable objects.
500 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextObject
, wxObject
)
502 wxRichTextObject::wxRichTextObject(wxRichTextObject
* parent
)
510 wxRichTextObject::~wxRichTextObject()
514 void wxRichTextObject::Dereference()
522 void wxRichTextObject::Copy(const wxRichTextObject
& obj
)
525 m_maxSize
= obj
.m_maxSize
;
526 m_minSize
= obj
.m_minSize
;
528 m_range
= obj
.m_range
;
529 m_ownRange
= obj
.m_ownRange
;
530 m_attributes
= obj
.m_attributes
;
531 m_properties
= obj
.m_properties
;
532 m_descent
= obj
.m_descent
;
536 // Get/set the top-level container of this object.
537 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* wxRichTextObject::GetContainer() const
539 const wxRichTextObject
* p
= this;
544 return wxDynamicCast(p
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
551 void wxRichTextObject::SetMargins(int margin
)
553 SetMargins(margin
, margin
, margin
, margin
);
556 void wxRichTextObject::SetMargins(int leftMargin
, int rightMargin
, int topMargin
, int bottomMargin
)
558 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft().SetValue(leftMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
559 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight().SetValue(rightMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
560 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop().SetValue(topMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
561 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetBottom().SetValue(bottomMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
564 int wxRichTextObject::GetLeftMargin() const
566 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft().GetValue();
569 int wxRichTextObject::GetRightMargin() const
571 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight().GetValue();
574 int wxRichTextObject::GetTopMargin() const
576 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop().GetValue();
579 int wxRichTextObject::GetBottomMargin() const
581 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetBottom().GetValue();
584 // Calculate the available content space in the given rectangle, given the
585 // margins, border and padding specified in the object's attributes.
586 wxRect
wxRichTextObject::GetAvailableContentArea(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& outerRect
) const
588 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
589 marginRect
= outerRect
;
590 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetAttributes());
591 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, (wxRichTextObject
*) this);
592 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
596 // Invalidate the buffer. With no argument, invalidates whole buffer.
597 void wxRichTextObject::Invalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
599 if (invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
601 // If this is a floating object, size may not be recalculated
602 // after floats have been collected in an early stage of Layout.
603 // So avoid resetting the cache for floating objects during layout.
604 if (!IsFloating() || !wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
605 SetCachedSize(wxDefaultSize
);
606 SetMaxSize(wxDefaultSize
);
607 SetMinSize(wxDefaultSize
);
611 // Convert units in tenths of a millimetre to device units
612 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(wxDC
& dc
, int units
) const
617 scale
= GetBuffer()->GetScale() / GetBuffer()->GetDimensionScale();
618 int p
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
.GetPPI().x
, units
, scale
);
623 // Convert units in tenths of a millimetre to device units
624 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(int ppi
, int units
, double scale
)
626 // There are ppi pixels in 254.1 "1/10 mm"
628 double pixels
= ((double) units
* (double)ppi
) / 254.1;
632 // If the result is very small, make it at least one pixel in size.
633 if (pixels
== 0 && units
> 0)
639 // Convert units in pixels to tenths of a millimetre
640 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(wxDC
& dc
, int pixels
) const
645 scale
= GetBuffer()->GetScale();
647 return ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(dc
.GetPPI().x
, p
, scale
);
650 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(int ppi
, int pixels
, double scale
)
652 // There are ppi pixels in 254.1 "1/10 mm"
654 double p
= double(pixels
);
659 int units
= int( p
* 254.1 / (double) ppi
);
663 // Draw the borders and background for the given rectangle and attributes.
664 // Width and height are taken to be the outer margin size, not the content.
665 bool wxRichTextObject::DrawBoxAttributes(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& boxRect
, int flags
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
667 // Assume boxRect is the area around the content
668 wxRect marginRect
= boxRect
;
669 wxRect contentRect
, borderRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
671 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
673 // Margin is transparent. Draw background from margin.
674 if (attr
.HasBackgroundColour() || (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_SELECTED
))
677 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_SELECTED
)
679 // TODO: get selection colour from control?
680 colour
= wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT
);
683 colour
= attr
.GetBackgroundColour();
686 wxBrush
brush(colour
);
690 dc
.DrawRectangle(borderRect
);
693 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_GUIDELINES
)
695 wxRichTextAttr editBorderAttr
;
696 // TODO: make guideline colour configurable
697 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().SetColour(*wxLIGHT_GREY
);
698 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().SetWidth(1, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
699 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().SetStyle(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_SOLID
);
703 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextCell
);
706 // This ensures that thin lines drawn by adjacent cells (left and above)
707 // don't get overwritten by the guidelines.
708 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetLeft().Reset();
709 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetTop().Reset();
713 DrawBorder(dc
, buffer
, editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder(), borderRect
, flags
);
716 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().IsValid())
717 DrawBorder(dc
, buffer
, attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder(), borderRect
);
719 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().IsValid())
720 DrawBorder(dc
, buffer
, attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline(), outlineRect
);
726 bool wxRichTextObject::DrawBorder(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxTextAttrBorders
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
728 int borderLeft
= 0, borderRight
= 0, borderTop
= 0, borderBottom
= 0;
729 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, buffer
? buffer
->GetScale() : 1.0);
731 if (attr
.GetLeft().IsValid() && attr
.GetLeft().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
733 borderLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetLeft().GetWidth());
734 wxColour
col(attr
.GetLeft().GetColour());
736 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
739 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
740 if (attr
.GetLeft().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
742 else if (attr
.GetLeft().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
743 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
744 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
747 // Note that the last point is not drawn.
748 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, rect
.x
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
);
750 else if (borderLeft
> 1)
756 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, borderLeft
, rect
.height
);
760 if (attr
.GetRight().IsValid() && attr
.GetRight().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
762 borderRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetRight().GetWidth());
764 wxColour
col(attr
.GetRight().GetColour());
766 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
767 if (borderRight
== 1)
769 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
770 if (attr
.GetRight().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
772 else if (attr
.GetRight().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
773 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
774 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
776 // Note that the last point is not drawn.
777 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
+ rect
.width
- 1, rect
.y
, rect
.x
+ rect
.width
- 1, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
);
779 else if (borderRight
> 1)
785 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
+ rect
.width
- borderRight
, rect
.y
, borderRight
, rect
.height
);
789 if (attr
.GetTop().IsValid() && attr
.GetTop().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
791 borderTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTop().GetWidth());
793 wxColour
col(attr
.GetTop().GetColour());
795 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
798 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
799 if (attr
.GetTop().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
801 else if (attr
.GetTop().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
802 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
803 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
805 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, rect
.x
+ rect
.width
, rect
.y
);
808 else if (borderTop
> 1)
814 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, rect
.width
, borderTop
);
818 if (attr
.GetBottom().IsValid() && attr
.GetBottom().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
820 borderBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetBottom().GetWidth());
821 wxColour
col(attr
.GetBottom().GetColour());
823 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
824 if (borderBottom
== 1)
826 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
827 if (attr
.GetBottom().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
829 else if (attr
.GetBottom().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
830 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
831 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
833 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
- 1, rect
.x
+ rect
.width
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
- 1);
835 else if (borderBottom
> 1)
841 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
- borderBottom
, rect
.width
, borderBottom
);
848 // Get the various rectangles of the box model in pixels. You can either specify contentRect (inner)
849 // or marginRect (outer), and the other must be the default rectangle (no width or height).
850 // Note that the outline doesn't affect the position of the rectangle, it's drawn in whatever space
853 // | Margin | Border | Padding | CONTENT | Padding | Border | Margin |
855 bool wxRichTextObject::GetBoxRects(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, wxRect
& marginRect
, wxRect
& borderRect
, wxRect
& contentRect
, wxRect
& paddingRect
, wxRect
& outlineRect
)
857 int borderLeft
= 0, borderRight
= 0, borderTop
= 0, borderBottom
= 0;
858 int outlineLeft
= 0, outlineRight
= 0, outlineTop
= 0, outlineBottom
= 0;
859 int paddingLeft
= 0, paddingRight
= 0, paddingTop
= 0, paddingBottom
= 0;
860 int marginLeft
= 0, marginRight
= 0, marginTop
= 0, marginBottom
= 0;
862 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, buffer
? buffer
->GetScale() : 1.0);
864 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft().IsValid())
865 marginLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft());
866 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight().IsValid())
867 marginRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight());
868 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop().IsValid())
869 marginTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop());
870 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetBottom().IsValid())
871 marginBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetBottom());
873 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetLeft().GetWidth().IsValid())
874 borderLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetLeft().GetWidth());
875 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetRight().GetWidth().IsValid())
876 borderRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetRight().GetWidth());
877 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetTop().GetWidth().IsValid())
878 borderTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetTop().GetWidth());
879 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetBottom().GetWidth().IsValid())
880 borderBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetBottom().GetWidth());
882 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft().IsValid())
883 paddingLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft());
884 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetRight().IsValid())
885 paddingRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetRight());
886 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop().IsValid())
887 paddingTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop());
888 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetBottom().IsValid())
889 paddingBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetBottom());
891 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetLeft().GetWidth().IsValid())
892 outlineLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetLeft().GetWidth());
893 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetRight().GetWidth().IsValid())
894 outlineRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetRight().GetWidth());
895 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetTop().GetWidth().IsValid())
896 outlineTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetTop().GetWidth());
897 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetBottom().GetWidth().IsValid())
898 outlineBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetBottom().GetWidth());
900 int leftTotal
= marginLeft
+ borderLeft
+ paddingLeft
;
901 int rightTotal
= marginRight
+ borderRight
+ paddingRight
;
902 int topTotal
= marginTop
+ borderTop
+ paddingTop
;
903 int bottomTotal
= marginBottom
+ borderBottom
+ paddingBottom
;
905 if (marginRect
!= wxRect())
907 contentRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
+ leftTotal
;
908 contentRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
+ topTotal
;
909 contentRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
- (leftTotal
+ rightTotal
);
910 contentRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
- (topTotal
+ bottomTotal
);
914 marginRect
.x
= contentRect
.x
- leftTotal
;
915 marginRect
.y
= contentRect
.y
- topTotal
;
916 marginRect
.width
= contentRect
.width
+ (leftTotal
+ rightTotal
);
917 marginRect
.height
= contentRect
.height
+ (topTotal
+ bottomTotal
);
920 borderRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
+ marginLeft
;
921 borderRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
+ marginTop
;
922 borderRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
- (marginLeft
+ marginRight
);
923 borderRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
- (marginTop
+ marginBottom
);
925 paddingRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
+ marginLeft
+ borderLeft
;
926 paddingRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
+ marginTop
+ borderTop
;
927 paddingRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
- (marginLeft
+ marginRight
+ borderLeft
+ borderRight
);
928 paddingRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
- (marginTop
+ marginBottom
+ borderTop
+ borderBottom
);
930 // The outline is outside the margin and doesn't influence the overall box position or content size.
931 outlineRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
- outlineLeft
;
932 outlineRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
- outlineTop
;
933 outlineRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
+ (outlineLeft
+ outlineRight
);
934 outlineRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
+ (outlineTop
+ outlineBottom
);
939 // Get the total margin for the object in pixels, taking into account margin, padding and border size
940 bool wxRichTextObject::GetTotalMargin(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, int& leftMargin
, int& rightMargin
,
941 int& topMargin
, int& bottomMargin
)
943 // Assume boxRect is the area around the content
944 wxRect contentRect
, marginRect
, borderRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
945 marginRect
= wxRect(0, 0, 1000, 1000);
947 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
949 leftMargin
= contentRect
.GetLeft() - marginRect
.GetLeft();
950 rightMargin
= marginRect
.GetRight() - contentRect
.GetRight();
951 topMargin
= contentRect
.GetTop() - marginRect
.GetTop();
952 bottomMargin
= marginRect
.GetBottom() - contentRect
.GetBottom();
957 // Returns the rectangle which the child has available to it given restrictions specified in the
958 // child attribute, e.g. 50% width of the parent, 400 pixels, x position 20% of the parent, etc.
959 // availableContainerSpace might be a parent that the cell has to compute its width relative to.
960 // E.g. a cell that's 50% of its parent.
961 wxRect
wxRichTextObject::AdjustAvailableSpace(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& WXUNUSED(parentAttr
), const wxRichTextAttr
& childAttr
, const wxRect
& availableParentSpace
, const wxRect
& availableContainerSpace
)
963 wxRect rect
= availableParentSpace
;
966 scale
= buffer
->GetScale();
968 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, availableContainerSpace
.GetSize());
970 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid())
971 rect
.width
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
973 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().IsValid())
974 rect
.height
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight());
976 // Can specify either left or right for the position (we're assuming we can't
977 // set the left and right edges to effectively set the size. Would we want to do that?)
978 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetLeft().IsValid())
980 rect
.x
= rect
.x
+ converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetLeft());
982 else if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetRight().IsValid())
984 int x
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetRight());
985 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetRight().GetPosition() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_POSITION_RELATIVE
)
986 rect
.x
= availableContainerSpace
.x
+ availableContainerSpace
.width
- rect
.width
;
991 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetTop().IsValid())
993 rect
.y
= rect
.y
+ converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetTop());
995 else if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetBottom().IsValid())
997 int y
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetBottom());
998 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetBottom().GetPosition() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_POSITION_RELATIVE
)
999 rect
.y
= availableContainerSpace
.y
+ availableContainerSpace
.height
- rect
.height
;
1004 if (rect
.GetWidth() > availableParentSpace
.GetWidth())
1005 rect
.SetWidth(availableParentSpace
.GetWidth());
1010 // Dump to output stream for debugging
1011 void wxRichTextObject::Dump(wxTextOutputStream
& stream
)
1013 stream
<< GetClassInfo()->GetClassName() << wxT("\n");
1014 stream
<< wxString::Format(wxT("Size: %d,%d. Position: %d,%d, Range: %ld,%ld"), m_size
.x
, m_size
.y
, m_pos
.x
, m_pos
.y
, m_range
.GetStart(), m_range
.GetEnd()) << wxT("\n");
1015 stream
<< wxString::Format(wxT("Text colour: %d,%d,%d."), (int) m_attributes
.GetTextColour().Red(), (int) m_attributes
.GetTextColour().Green(), (int) m_attributes
.GetTextColour().Blue()) << wxT("\n");
1018 // Gets the containing buffer
1019 wxRichTextBuffer
* wxRichTextObject::GetBuffer() const
1021 const wxRichTextObject
* obj
= this;
1022 while (obj
&& !wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextBuffer
))
1023 obj
= obj
->GetParent();
1024 return wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextBuffer
);
1027 // Get the absolute object position, by traversing up the child/parent hierarchy
1028 wxPoint
wxRichTextObject::GetAbsolutePosition() const
1030 wxPoint pt
= GetPosition();
1032 wxRichTextObject
* p
= GetParent();
1035 pt
= pt
+ p
->GetPosition();
1042 // Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
1043 // information about position
1044 int wxRichTextObject::HitTest(wxDC
& WXUNUSED(dc
), wxRichTextDrawingContext
& WXUNUSED(context
), const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
1047 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1049 wxRect rect
= GetRect();
1050 if (pt
.x
>= rect
.x
&& pt
.x
< rect
.x
+ rect
.width
&&
1051 pt
.y
>= rect
.y
&& pt
.y
< rect
.y
+ rect
.height
)
1054 *contextObj
= GetParentContainer();
1055 textPosition
= GetRange().GetStart();
1056 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_ON
;
1059 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1062 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
1063 // lays out the object again using the maximum ('best') size
1064 bool wxRichTextObject::LayoutToBestSize(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
,
1065 const wxRichTextAttr
& parentAttr
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
,
1066 const wxRect
& availableParentSpace
, const wxRect
& availableContainerSpace
,
1069 wxRect availableChildRect
= AdjustAvailableSpace(dc
, buffer
, parentAttr
, attr
, availableParentSpace
, availableContainerSpace
);
1070 wxRect originalAvailableRect
= availableChildRect
;
1071 Layout(dc
, context
, availableChildRect
, availableContainerSpace
, style
);
1073 wxSize maxSize
= GetMaxSize();
1075 // Don't ignore if maxSize.x is zero, since we need to redo the paragraph's lines
1077 if (!attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid() && maxSize
.x
< availableChildRect
.width
)
1079 // Redo the layout with a fixed, minimum size this time.
1080 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
1081 wxRichTextAttr
newAttr(attr
);
1082 newAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().SetValue(maxSize
.x
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
1083 newAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().SetPosition(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_POSITION_ABSOLUTE
);
1085 availableChildRect
= AdjustAvailableSpace(dc
, buffer
, parentAttr
, newAttr
, availableParentSpace
, availableContainerSpace
);
1087 // If a paragraph, align the whole paragraph.
1088 // Problem with this: if we're limited by a floating object, a line may be centered
1089 // w.r.t. the smaller resulting box rather than the actual available width.
1090 // FIXME: aligning whole paragraph not compatible with floating objects
1091 if (attr
.HasAlignment() && (!wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() || (GetContainer()->GetFloatCollector() && !GetContainer()->GetFloatCollector()->HasFloats())))
1093 // centering, right-justification
1094 if (attr
.GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_CENTRE
)
1096 availableChildRect
.x
= (originalAvailableRect
.GetWidth() - availableChildRect
.GetWidth())/2 + availableChildRect
.x
;
1098 else if (attr
.GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_RIGHT
)
1100 availableChildRect
.x
= availableChildRect
.x
+ originalAvailableRect
.GetWidth() - availableChildRect
.GetWidth();
1104 Layout(dc
, context
, availableChildRect
, availableContainerSpace
, style
);
1118 // Move the object recursively, by adding the offset from old to new
1119 void wxRichTextObject::Move(const wxPoint
& pt
)
1126 * wxRichTextCompositeObject
1127 * This is the base for drawable objects.
1130 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextCompositeObject
, wxRichTextObject
)
1132 wxRichTextCompositeObject::wxRichTextCompositeObject(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
1133 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
1137 wxRichTextCompositeObject::~wxRichTextCompositeObject()
1142 /// Get the nth child
1143 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetChild(size_t n
) const
1145 wxASSERT ( n
< m_children
.GetCount() );
1147 return m_children
.Item(n
)->GetData();
1150 /// Append a child, returning the position
1151 size_t wxRichTextCompositeObject::AppendChild(wxRichTextObject
* child
)
1153 m_children
.Append(child
);
1154 child
->SetParent(this);
1155 return m_children
.GetCount() - 1;
1158 /// Insert the child in front of the given object, or at the beginning
1159 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::InsertChild(wxRichTextObject
* child
, wxRichTextObject
* inFrontOf
)
1163 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(inFrontOf
);
1164 m_children
.Insert(node
, child
);
1167 m_children
.Insert(child
);
1168 child
->SetParent(this);
1173 /// Delete the child
1174 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::RemoveChild(wxRichTextObject
* child
, bool deleteChild
)
1176 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(child
);
1179 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
1180 m_children
.Erase(node
);
1189 /// Delete all children
1190 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::DeleteChildren()
1192 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1195 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator oldNode
= node
;
1197 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1198 child
->Dereference(); // Only delete if reference count is zero
1200 node
= node
->GetNext();
1201 m_children
.Erase(oldNode
);
1207 /// Get the child count
1208 size_t wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetChildCount() const
1210 return m_children
.GetCount();
1214 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Copy(const wxRichTextCompositeObject
& obj
)
1216 wxRichTextObject::Copy(obj
);
1220 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= obj
.m_children
.GetFirst();
1223 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1224 wxRichTextObject
* newChild
= child
->Clone();
1225 newChild
->SetParent(this);
1226 m_children
.Append(newChild
);
1228 node
= node
->GetNext();
1232 /// Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
1233 /// information about position
1234 int wxRichTextCompositeObject::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
1237 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1239 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1242 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1244 if (child
->IsShown() && child
->IsTopLevel() && (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NO_NESTED_OBJECTS
))
1246 // Just check if we hit the overall object
1247 int ret
= child
->wxRichTextObject::HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
1248 if (ret
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
1251 else if (child
->IsShown())
1253 int ret
= child
->HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
1254 if (ret
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
1258 node
= node
->GetNext();
1261 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1264 /// Finds the absolute position and row height for the given character position
1265 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::FindPosition(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, long index
, wxPoint
& pt
, int* height
, bool forceLineStart
)
1267 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1270 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1272 // Don't recurse if the child is a top-level object,
1273 // such as a text box, because the character position will no longer
1274 // apply. By definition, a top-level object has its own range of
1275 // character positions.
1276 if (!child
->IsTopLevel() && child
->FindPosition(dc
, context
, index
, pt
, height
, forceLineStart
))
1279 node
= node
->GetNext();
1286 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
1288 long current
= start
;
1289 long lastEnd
= current
;
1297 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1300 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1303 child
->CalculateRange(current
, childEnd
);
1306 current
= childEnd
+ 1;
1308 node
= node
->GetNext();
1313 // A top-level object always has a range of size 1,
1314 // because its children don't count at this level.
1316 m_range
.SetRange(start
, start
);
1318 // An object with no children has zero length
1319 if (m_children
.GetCount() == 0)
1321 m_ownRange
.SetRange(0, lastEnd
);
1327 // An object with no children has zero length
1328 if (m_children
.GetCount() == 0)
1331 m_range
.SetRange(start
, end
);
1335 /// Delete range from layout.
1336 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
1338 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1342 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= (wxRichTextObject
*) node
->GetData();
1343 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
1345 // Delete the range in each paragraph
1347 // When a chunk has been deleted, internally the content does not
1348 // now match the ranges.
1349 // However, so long as deletion is not done on the same object twice this is OK.
1350 // If you may delete content from the same object twice, recalculate
1351 // the ranges inbetween DeleteRange calls by calling CalculateRanges, and
1352 // adjust the range you're deleting accordingly.
1354 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1356 // No need to delete within a top-level object; just removing this object will do fine
1357 if (!obj
->IsTopLevel())
1358 obj
->DeleteRange(range
);
1360 // Delete an empty object, or paragraph within this range.
1361 if (obj
->IsEmpty() ||
1362 (range
.GetStart() <= obj
->GetRange().GetStart() && range
.GetEnd() >= obj
->GetRange().GetEnd()))
1364 // An empty paragraph has length 1, so won't be deleted unless the
1365 // whole range is deleted.
1366 RemoveChild(obj
, true);
1376 /// Get any text in this object for the given range
1377 wxString
wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
1380 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1383 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1384 wxRichTextRange childRange
= range
;
1385 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1387 childRange
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
1389 wxString childText
= child
->GetTextForRange(childRange
);
1393 node
= node
->GetNext();
1399 /// Get the child object at the given character position
1400 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetChildAtPosition(long pos
) const
1402 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1405 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1406 if (child
->GetRange().GetStart() == pos
)
1408 node
= node
->GetNext();
1413 /// Recursively merge all pieces that can be merged.
1414 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::Defragment(wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
1416 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1419 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1420 if (range
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1422 wxRichTextCompositeObject
* composite
= wxDynamicCast(child
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
);
1424 composite
->Defragment(context
);
1426 // Optimization: if there are no virtual attributes, we won't need to
1427 // to split objects in order to paint individually attributed chunks.
1428 // So only merge in this case.
1429 if (!context
.GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
1431 if (node
->GetNext())
1433 wxRichTextObject
* nextChild
= node
->GetNext()->GetData();
1434 if (child
->CanMerge(nextChild
, context
) && child
->Merge(nextChild
, context
))
1436 nextChild
->Dereference();
1437 m_children
.Erase(node
->GetNext());
1440 node
= node
->GetNext();
1443 node
= node
->GetNext();
1447 // If we might have virtual attributes, we first see if we have to split
1448 // objects so that they may be painted with potential virtual attributes,
1449 // since text objects can only draw or measure with a single attributes object
1451 wxRichTextObject
* childAfterSplit
= child
;
1452 if (child
->CanSplit(context
))
1454 childAfterSplit
= child
->Split(context
);
1455 node
= m_children
.Find(childAfterSplit
);
1458 if (node
->GetNext())
1460 wxRichTextObject
* nextChild
= node
->GetNext()->GetData();
1462 // First split child and nextChild so we have smaller fragments to merge.
1463 // Then Merge only has to test per-object virtual attributes
1464 // because for an object with all the same sub-object attributes,
1465 // then any general virtual attributes should be merged with sub-objects by
1466 // the implementation.
1468 wxRichTextObject
* nextChildAfterSplit
= nextChild
;
1470 if (nextChildAfterSplit
->CanSplit(context
))
1471 nextChildAfterSplit
= nextChild
->Split(context
);
1473 bool splitNextChild
= nextChild
!= nextChildAfterSplit
;
1475 // See if we can merge this new fragment with (perhaps the first part of) the next object.
1476 // Note that we use nextChild because if we had split nextChild, the first object always
1477 // remains (and further parts are appended). However we must use childAfterSplit since
1478 // it's the last part of a possibly split child.
1480 if (childAfterSplit
->CanMerge(nextChild
, context
) && childAfterSplit
->Merge(nextChild
, context
))
1482 nextChild
->Dereference();
1483 m_children
.Erase(node
->GetNext());
1485 // Don't set node -- we'll see if we can merge again with the next
1486 // child. UNLESS we split this or the next child, in which case we know we have to
1487 // move on to the end of the next child.
1489 node
= m_children
.Find(nextChildAfterSplit
);
1494 node
= m_children
.Find(nextChildAfterSplit
); // start from the last object in the split
1496 node
= node
->GetNext();
1500 node
= node
->GetNext();
1504 node
= node
->GetNext();
1507 // Delete any remaining empty objects, but leave at least one empty object per composite object.
1508 if (GetChildCount() > 1)
1510 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1513 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
1514 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1515 if (range
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1517 if (child
->IsEmpty())
1519 child
->Dereference();
1520 m_children
.Erase(node
);
1525 node
= node
->GetNext();
1532 /// Dump to output stream for debugging
1533 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Dump(wxTextOutputStream
& stream
)
1535 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1538 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1539 child
->Dump(stream
);
1540 node
= node
->GetNext();
1544 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
1545 /// is invalid for this object.
1546 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int flags
, const wxPoint
& position
, const wxSize
& parentSize
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
1548 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
1553 wxArrayInt childExtents
;
1560 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1563 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1564 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1566 // Floating objects have a zero size within the paragraph.
1567 if (child
->IsFloating() && wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
1572 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
1573 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
1577 partialExtents
->Add(0 /* zero size */ + lastSize
);
1584 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= range
;
1585 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
1586 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
1587 rangeToUse
= child
->GetOwnRange();
1589 int childDescent
= 0;
1591 // At present wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY is only fast if we're already cached the size,
1592 // but it's only going to be used after caching has taken place.
1593 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
) && child
->GetCachedSize().y
!= 0)
1595 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
1596 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
1598 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, childSize
.y
);
1599 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
1600 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
1602 else if (child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, flags
, wxPoint(position
.x
+ sz
.x
, position
.y
), parentSize
, p
))
1604 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, childSize
.y
);
1605 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
1606 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
1608 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
) && (rangeToUse
== child
->GetRange() || child
->IsTopLevel()))
1610 child
->SetCachedSize(childSize
);
1611 child
->SetDescent(childDescent
);
1617 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
1618 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
1623 for (i
= 0; i
< childExtents
.GetCount(); i
++)
1625 partialExtents
->Add(childExtents
[i
] + lastSize
);
1635 node
= node
->GetNext();
1641 // Invalidate the buffer. With no argument, invalidates whole buffer.
1642 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Invalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
1644 wxRichTextObject::Invalidate(invalidRange
);
1646 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1649 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1650 if (invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_ALL
&& invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
&& child
->GetRange().IsOutside(invalidRange
))
1654 else if (child
->IsTopLevel())
1656 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && child
->IsFloating() && GetBuffer()->GetFloatCollector() && GetBuffer()->GetFloatCollector()->HasFloat(child
))
1658 // Don't invalidate subhierarchy if we've already been laid out
1662 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
1663 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_NONE
);
1665 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
); // All children must be invalidated if within parent range
1669 child
->Invalidate(invalidRange
);
1670 node
= node
->GetNext();
1674 // Move the object recursively, by adding the offset from old to new
1675 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Move(const wxPoint
& pt
)
1677 wxPoint oldPos
= GetPosition();
1679 wxPoint offset
= pt
- oldPos
;
1681 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1684 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1685 wxPoint childPos
= child
->GetPosition() + offset
;
1686 child
->Move(childPos
);
1687 node
= node
->GetNext();
1693 * wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
1694 * This box knows how to lay out paragraphs.
1697 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
)
1699 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
1700 wxRichTextCompositeObject(parent
)
1705 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::~wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox()
1707 if (m_floatCollector
)
1709 delete m_floatCollector
;
1710 m_floatCollector
= NULL
;
1714 /// Initialize the object.
1715 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Init()
1719 // For now, assume is the only box and has no initial size.
1720 m_range
= wxRichTextRange(0, -1);
1721 m_ownRange
= wxRichTextRange(0, -1);
1723 m_invalidRange
= wxRICHTEXT_ALL
;
1725 m_partialParagraph
= false;
1726 m_floatCollector
= NULL
;
1729 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Clear()
1733 if (m_floatCollector
)
1734 delete m_floatCollector
;
1735 m_floatCollector
= NULL
;
1736 m_partialParagraph
= false;
1740 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Copy(const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& obj
)
1744 wxRichTextCompositeObject::Copy(obj
);
1746 m_partialParagraph
= obj
.m_partialParagraph
;
1747 m_defaultAttributes
= obj
.m_defaultAttributes
;
1750 // Gather information about floating objects; only gather floats for those paragraphs that
1751 // will not be formatted again due to optimization, after which floats will be gathered per-paragraph
1753 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::UpdateFloatingObjects(const wxRect
& availableRect
, wxRichTextObject
* untilObj
)
1755 if (m_floatCollector
!= NULL
)
1756 delete m_floatCollector
;
1757 m_floatCollector
= new wxRichTextFloatCollector(availableRect
);
1758 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1759 // Only gather floats up to the point we'll start formatting paragraphs.
1760 while (untilObj
&& node
&& node
->GetData() != untilObj
)
1762 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
1763 wxASSERT (child
!= NULL
);
1765 m_floatCollector
->CollectFloat(child
);
1766 node
= node
->GetNext();
1772 // Returns the style sheet associated with the overall buffer.
1773 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyleSheet() const
1775 return GetBuffer() ? GetBuffer()->GetStyleSheet() : (wxRichTextStyleSheet
*) NULL
;
1778 // Get the number of floating objects at this level
1779 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetFloatingObjectCount() const
1781 if (m_floatCollector
)
1782 return m_floatCollector
->GetFloatingObjectCount();
1787 // Get a list of floating objects
1788 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetFloatingObjects(wxRichTextObjectList
& objects
) const
1790 if (m_floatCollector
)
1792 return m_floatCollector
->GetFloatingObjects(objects
);
1799 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::UpdateRanges()
1803 start
= GetRange().GetStart();
1805 CalculateRange(start
, end
);
1809 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
1812 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1814 int ret
= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1815 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && m_floatCollector
&& (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NO_FLOATING_OBJECTS
) == 0)
1816 ret
= m_floatCollector
->HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, flags
);
1818 if (ret
== wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
1819 return wxRichTextCompositeObject::HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
1827 /// Draw the floating objects
1828 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DrawFloats(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
1830 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && m_floatCollector
)
1831 m_floatCollector
->Draw(dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
1834 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::MoveAnchoredObjectToParagraph(wxRichTextParagraph
* from
, wxRichTextParagraph
* to
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
1839 from
->RemoveChild(obj
);
1840 to
->AppendChild(obj
);
1844 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
1849 wxRect
thisRect(GetPosition(), GetCachedSize());
1851 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetAttributes());
1852 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, this);
1855 if (selection
.IsValid() && GetParentContainer() != this && selection
.GetContainer() == this && selection
.WithinSelection(GetRange().GetStart(), GetParentContainer()))
1856 flags
|= wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_SELECTED
;
1858 // Don't draw guidelines if at top level
1859 int theseFlags
= flags
;
1861 theseFlags
&= ~wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_GUIDELINES
;
1862 DrawBoxAttributes(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, thisRect
, theseFlags
, this);
1864 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
1865 DrawFloats(dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
1867 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1870 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1872 if (child
&& !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1874 wxRect
childRect(child
->GetPosition(), child
->GetCachedSize());
1875 wxRichTextRange childRange
= range
;
1876 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
1878 childRange
= child
->GetOwnRange();
1881 if (((style
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_IGNORE_CACHE
) == 0) && childRect
.GetTop() > rect
.GetBottom())
1886 else if (((style
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_IGNORE_CACHE
) == 0) && childRect
.GetBottom() < rect
.GetTop())
1891 child
->Draw(dc
, context
, childRange
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
1894 node
= node
->GetNext();
1899 /// Lay the item out
1900 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxRect
& parentRect
, int style
)
1902 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
1907 wxRect availableSpace
;
1908 bool formatRect
= (style
& wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
) == wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
;
1910 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetAttributes());
1911 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, this);
1913 // If only laying out a specific area, the passed rect has a different meaning:
1914 // the visible part of the buffer. This is used in wxRichTextCtrl::OnSize,
1915 // so that during a size, only the visible part will be relaid out, or
1916 // it would take too long causing flicker. As an approximation, we assume that
1917 // everything up to the start of the visible area is laid out correctly.
1920 wxRect
rect2(0, 0, rect
.width
, rect
.height
);
1921 availableSpace
= GetAvailableContentArea(dc
, context
, rect2
);
1923 // Invalidate the part of the buffer from the first visible line
1924 // to the end. If other parts of the buffer are currently invalid,
1925 // then they too will be taken into account if they are above
1926 // the visible point.
1928 wxRichTextLine
* line
= GetLineAtYPosition(rect
.y
);
1930 startPos
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange().GetStart();
1932 Invalidate(wxRichTextRange(startPos
, GetOwnRange().GetEnd()));
1936 availableSpace
= GetAvailableContentArea(dc
, context
, rect
);
1939 // Fix the width if we're at the top level
1941 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().SetValue(rect
.GetWidth(), wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
1943 int leftMargin
, rightMargin
, topMargin
, bottomMargin
;
1944 wxRichTextObject::GetTotalMargin(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, leftMargin
, rightMargin
,
1945 topMargin
, bottomMargin
);
1950 // The maximum paragraph maximum width, so we can set the overall maximum width for this object
1951 int maxMaxWidth
= 0;
1953 // The maximum paragraph minimum width, so we can set the overall minimum width for this object
1954 int maxMinWidth
= 0;
1956 // If we have vertical alignment, we must recalculate everything.
1957 bool hasVerticalAlignment
= (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().HasVerticalAlignment() &&
1958 (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() > wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_TOP
));
1960 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1962 bool layoutAll
= true;
1964 // Get invalid range, rounding to paragraph start/end.
1965 wxRichTextRange invalidRange
= GetInvalidRange(true);
1967 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_NONE
&& !formatRect
)
1970 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| hasVerticalAlignment
)
1972 else // If we know what range is affected, start laying out from that point on.
1973 if (invalidRange
.GetStart() >= GetOwnRange().GetStart())
1975 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstParagraph
= GetParagraphAtPosition(invalidRange
.GetStart());
1978 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstNode
= m_children
.Find(firstParagraph
);
1979 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator previousNode
;
1981 previousNode
= firstNode
->GetPrevious();
1986 wxRichTextParagraph
* previousParagraph
= wxDynamicCast(previousNode
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
1987 availableSpace
.y
= previousParagraph
->GetPosition().y
+ previousParagraph
->GetCachedSize().y
;
1990 // Now we're going to start iterating from the first affected paragraph.
1998 // Gather information about only those floating objects that will not be formatted,
1999 // after which floats will be gathered per-paragraph during layout.
2000 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
2001 UpdateFloatingObjects(availableSpace
, node
? node
->GetData() : (wxRichTextObject
*) NULL
);
2003 // A way to force speedy rest-of-buffer layout (the 'else' below)
2004 bool forceQuickLayout
= false;
2006 // First get the size of the paragraphs we won't be laying out
2007 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator n
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2008 while (n
&& n
!= node
)
2010 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(n
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2013 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, child
->GetCachedSize().x
);
2014 maxMinWidth
= wxMax(maxMinWidth
, child
->GetMinSize().x
);
2015 maxMaxWidth
= wxMax(maxMaxWidth
, child
->GetMaxSize().x
);
2022 // Assume this box only contains paragraphs
2024 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2025 // Unsure if this is needed
2026 // wxCHECK_MSG( child, false, wxT("Unknown object in layout") );
2028 if (child
&& child
->IsShown())
2030 // TODO: what if the child hasn't been laid out (e.g. involved in Undo) but still has 'old' lines
2031 if ( !forceQuickLayout
&&
2033 child
->GetLines().IsEmpty() ||
2034 !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(invalidRange
)) )
2036 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
2037 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
2038 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, context
, GetBuffer(),
2039 attr
, child
->GetAttributes(), availableSpace
, rect
, style
&~wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
);
2041 // Layout must set the cached size
2042 availableSpace
.y
+= child
->GetCachedSize().y
;
2043 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, child
->GetCachedSize().x
);
2044 maxMinWidth
= wxMax(maxMinWidth
, child
->GetMinSize().x
);
2045 maxMaxWidth
= wxMax(maxMaxWidth
, child
->GetMaxSize().x
);
2047 // If we're just formatting the visible part of the buffer,
2048 // and we're now past the bottom of the window, and we don't have any
2049 // floating objects (since they may cause wrapping to change for the rest of the
2050 // the buffer), start quick layout.
2051 if (!hasVerticalAlignment
&& formatRect
&& child
->GetPosition().y
> rect
.GetBottom() && GetFloatingObjectCount() == 0)
2052 forceQuickLayout
= true;
2056 // We're outside the immediately affected range, so now let's just
2057 // move everything up or down. This assumes that all the children have previously
2058 // been laid out and have wrapped line lists associated with them.
2059 // TODO: check all paragraphs before the affected range.
2061 int inc
= availableSpace
.y
- child
->GetPosition().y
;
2065 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2068 if (child
->GetLines().GetCount() == 0)
2070 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
2071 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
2072 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, context
, GetBuffer(),
2073 attr
, child
->GetAttributes(), availableSpace
, rect
, style
&~wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
);
2075 //child->Layout(dc, availableChildRect, style);
2078 child
->Move(wxPoint(child
->GetPosition().x
, child
->GetPosition().y
+ inc
));
2080 availableSpace
.y
+= child
->GetCachedSize().y
;
2081 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, child
->GetCachedSize().x
);
2082 maxMinWidth
= wxMax(maxMinWidth
, child
->GetMinSize().x
);
2083 maxMaxWidth
= wxMax(maxMaxWidth
, child
->GetMaxSize().x
);
2086 node
= node
->GetNext();
2092 node
= node
->GetNext();
2095 node
= m_children
.GetLast();
2096 if (node
&& node
->GetData()->IsShown())
2098 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2099 maxHeight
= child
->GetPosition().y
- (GetPosition().y
+ topMargin
) + child
->GetCachedSize().y
;
2102 maxHeight
= 0; // topMargin + bottomMargin;
2104 // Check the bottom edge of any floating object
2105 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && GetFloatCollector() && GetFloatCollector()->HasFloats())
2107 int bottom
= GetFloatCollector()->GetLastRectBottom();
2108 if (bottom
> maxHeight
)
2112 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetSize().GetWidth().IsValid())
2114 wxRect r
= AdjustAvailableSpace(dc
, GetBuffer(), wxRichTextAttr() /* not used */, attr
, parentRect
, parentRect
);
2115 int w
= r
.GetWidth();
2117 // Convert external to content rect
2118 w
= w
- leftMargin
- rightMargin
;
2119 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, w
);
2120 maxMaxWidth
= wxMax(maxMaxWidth
, w
);
2124 // TODO: Make sure the layout box's position reflects
2125 // the position of the children, but without
2126 // breaking layout of a box within a paragraph.
2129 // TODO: (also in para layout) should set the
2130 // object's size to an absolute one if specified,
2131 // but if not specified, calculate it from content.
2133 // We need to add back the margins etc.
2135 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
2136 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxWidth
, maxHeight
));
2137 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
2138 SetCachedSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
2141 // The maximum size is the greatest of all maximum widths for all paragraphs.
2143 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
2144 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxMaxWidth
, maxHeight
)); // Actually max height is a lie, we can't know it
2145 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
2146 SetMaxSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
2149 // The minimum size is the greatest of all minimum widths for all paragraphs.
2151 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
2152 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxMinWidth
, maxHeight
)); // Actually max height is a lie, we can't know it
2153 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
2154 SetMinSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
2157 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().HasVerticalAlignment() &&
2158 (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() > wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_TOP
))
2161 int leftOverSpace
= availableSpace
.height
- topMargin
- bottomMargin
- maxHeight
;
2162 if (leftOverSpace
> 0)
2164 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_CENTRE
)
2166 yOffset
= (leftOverSpace
/2);
2168 else if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_BOTTOM
)
2170 yOffset
= leftOverSpace
;
2174 // Move all the children to vertically align the content
2175 // This doesn't take into account floating objects, unfortunately.
2178 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2181 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2183 child
->Move(wxPoint(child
->GetPosition().x
, child
->GetPosition().y
+ yOffset
));
2185 node
= node
->GetNext();
2190 m_invalidRange
= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
;
2195 /// Get/set the size for the given range.
2196 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int flags
, const wxPoint
& position
, const wxSize
& parentSize
, wxArrayInt
* WXUNUSED(partialExtents
)) const
2200 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator startPara
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
2201 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator endPara
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
2203 // First find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2204 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2207 // child is a paragraph
2208 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2209 const wxRichTextRange
& r
= child
->GetRange();
2211 if (r
.GetStart() <= range
.GetStart() && r
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetStart())
2217 node
= node
->GetNext();
2220 // Next find the last paragraph containing part of the range
2221 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2224 // child is a paragraph
2225 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2226 const wxRichTextRange
& r
= child
->GetRange();
2228 if (r
.GetStart() <= range
.GetEnd() && r
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetEnd())
2234 node
= node
->GetNext();
2237 if (!startPara
|| !endPara
)
2240 // Now we can add up the sizes
2241 for (node
= startPara
; node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
2243 // child is a paragraph
2244 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2245 const wxRichTextRange
& childRange
= child
->GetRange();
2246 wxRichTextRange rangeToFind
= range
;
2247 rangeToFind
.LimitTo(childRange
);
2249 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
2250 rangeToFind
= child
->GetOwnRange();
2254 int childDescent
= 0;
2255 child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToFind
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, flags
, position
, parentSize
);
2257 descent
= wxMax(childDescent
, descent
);
2259 sz
.x
= wxMax(sz
.x
, childSize
.x
);
2260 sz
.y
+= childSize
.y
;
2262 if (node
== endPara
)
2271 /// Get the paragraph at the given position
2272 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphAtPosition(long pos
, bool caretPosition
) const
2277 // First find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2278 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2281 // child is a paragraph
2282 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2283 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2287 // Return first child in buffer if position is -1
2291 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
2295 node
= node
->GetNext();
2300 /// Get the line at the given position
2301 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineAtPosition(long pos
, bool caretPosition
) const
2306 // First find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2307 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2310 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= (wxRichTextObject
*) node
->GetData();
2311 if (obj
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
2313 // child is a paragraph
2314 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextParagraph
);
2315 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2319 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2322 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2324 wxRichTextRange range
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
2326 if (range
.Contains(pos
) ||
2328 // If the position is end-of-paragraph, then return the last line of
2329 // of the paragraph.
2330 ((range
.GetEnd() == child
->GetRange().GetEnd()-1) && (pos
== child
->GetRange().GetEnd())))
2333 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2338 node
= node
->GetNext();
2341 int lineCount
= GetLineCount();
2343 return GetLineForVisibleLineNumber(lineCount
-1);
2348 /// Get the line at the given y pixel position, or the last line.
2349 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineAtYPosition(int y
) const
2351 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2354 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2355 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2359 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2362 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2364 wxRect
rect(line
->GetRect());
2366 if (y
<= rect
.GetBottom())
2369 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2373 node
= node
->GetNext();
2377 int lineCount
= GetLineCount();
2379 return GetLineForVisibleLineNumber(lineCount
-1);
2384 /// Get the number of visible lines
2385 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineCount() const
2389 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2392 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2393 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2396 count
+= child
->GetLines().GetCount();
2398 node
= node
->GetNext();
2404 /// Get the paragraph for a given line
2405 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphForLine(wxRichTextLine
* line
) const
2407 return GetParagraphAtPosition(line
->GetAbsoluteRange().GetStart());
2410 /// Get the line size at the given position
2411 wxSize
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineSizeAtPosition(long pos
, bool caretPosition
) const
2413 wxRichTextLine
* line
= GetLineAtPosition(pos
, caretPosition
);
2416 return line
->GetSize();
2419 return wxSize(0, 0);
2423 /// Convenience function to add a paragraph of text
2424 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::AddParagraph(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
)
2426 // Don't use the base style, just the default style, and the base style will
2427 // be combined at display time.
2428 // Divide into paragraph and character styles.
2430 wxRichTextAttr defaultCharStyle
;
2431 wxRichTextAttr defaultParaStyle
;
2433 // If the default style is a named paragraph style, don't apply any character formatting
2434 // to the initial text string.
2435 if (GetDefaultStyle().HasParagraphStyleName() && GetStyleSheet())
2437 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(GetDefaultStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
2439 defaultParaStyle
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
2442 wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(GetDefaultStyle(), defaultParaStyle
, defaultCharStyle
);
2444 wxRichTextAttr
* pStyle
= paraStyle
? paraStyle
: (wxRichTextAttr
*) & defaultParaStyle
;
2445 wxRichTextAttr
* cStyle
= & defaultCharStyle
;
2447 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(text
, this, pStyle
, cStyle
);
2448 para
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
2454 return para
->GetRange();
2457 /// Adds multiple paragraphs, based on newlines.
2458 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::AddParagraphs(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
)
2460 // Don't use the base style, just the default style, and the base style will
2461 // be combined at display time.
2462 // Divide into paragraph and character styles.
2464 wxRichTextAttr defaultCharStyle
;
2465 wxRichTextAttr defaultParaStyle
;
2467 // If the default style is a named paragraph style, don't apply any character formatting
2468 // to the initial text string.
2469 if (GetDefaultStyle().HasParagraphStyleName() && GetStyleSheet())
2471 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(GetDefaultStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
2473 defaultParaStyle
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
2476 wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(GetDefaultStyle(), defaultParaStyle
, defaultCharStyle
);
2478 wxRichTextAttr
* pStyle
= paraStyle
? paraStyle
: (wxRichTextAttr
*) & defaultParaStyle
;
2479 wxRichTextAttr
* cStyle
= & defaultCharStyle
;
2481 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= NULL
;
2482 wxRichTextParagraph
* lastPara
= NULL
;
2484 wxRichTextRange
range(-1, -1);
2487 size_t len
= text
.length();
2489 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(wxEmptyString
, this, pStyle
, cStyle
);
2490 para
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
2499 wxChar ch
= text
[i
];
2500 if (ch
== wxT('\n') || ch
== wxT('\r'))
2504 wxRichTextPlainText
* plainText
= (wxRichTextPlainText
*) para
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
2505 plainText
->SetText(line
);
2507 para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(wxEmptyString
, this, pStyle
, cStyle
);
2508 para
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
2513 line
= wxEmptyString
;
2524 wxRichTextPlainText
* plainText
= (wxRichTextPlainText
*) para
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
2525 plainText
->SetText(line
);
2530 return wxRichTextRange(firstPara
->GetRange().GetStart(), lastPara
->GetRange().GetEnd());
2533 /// Convenience function to add an image
2534 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::AddImage(const wxImage
& image
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
)
2536 // Don't use the base style, just the default style, and the base style will
2537 // be combined at display time.
2538 // Divide into paragraph and character styles.
2540 wxRichTextAttr defaultCharStyle
;
2541 wxRichTextAttr defaultParaStyle
;
2543 // If the default style is a named paragraph style, don't apply any character formatting
2544 // to the initial text string.
2545 if (GetDefaultStyle().HasParagraphStyleName() && GetStyleSheet())
2547 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(GetDefaultStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
2549 defaultParaStyle
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
2552 wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(GetDefaultStyle(), defaultParaStyle
, defaultCharStyle
);
2554 wxRichTextAttr
* pStyle
= paraStyle
? paraStyle
: (wxRichTextAttr
*) & defaultParaStyle
;
2555 wxRichTextAttr
* cStyle
= & defaultCharStyle
;
2557 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(this, pStyle
);
2558 para
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
2560 para
->AppendChild(new wxRichTextImage(image
, this, cStyle
));
2564 return para
->GetRange();
2568 /// Insert fragment into this box at the given position. If partialParagraph is true,
2569 /// it is assumed that the last (or only) paragraph is just a piece of data with no paragraph
2572 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertFragment(long position
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& fragment
)
2574 // First, find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2575 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(position
);
2578 wxRichTextAttr originalAttr
= para
->GetAttributes();
2580 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(para
);
2582 // Now split at this position, returning the object to insert the new
2583 // ones in front of.
2584 wxRichTextObject
* nextObject
= para
->SplitAt(position
);
2586 // Special case: partial paragraph, just one paragraph. Might be a small amount of
2587 // text, for example, so let's optimize.
2589 if (fragment
.GetPartialParagraph() && fragment
.GetChildren().GetCount() == 1)
2591 // Add the first para to this para...
2592 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstParaNode
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
2596 // Iterate through the fragment paragraph inserting the content into this paragraph.
2597 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= wxDynamicCast(firstParaNode
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2598 wxASSERT (firstPara
!= NULL
);
2600 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator objectNode
= firstPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
2603 wxRichTextObject
* newObj
= objectNode
->GetData()->Clone();
2608 para
->AppendChild(newObj
);
2612 // Insert before nextObject
2613 para
->InsertChild(newObj
, nextObject
);
2616 objectNode
= objectNode
->GetNext();
2623 // Procedure for inserting a fragment consisting of a number of
2626 // 1. Remove and save the content that's after the insertion point, for adding
2627 // back once we've added the fragment.
2628 // 2. Add the content from the first fragment paragraph to the current
2630 // 3. Add remaining fragment paragraphs after the current paragraph.
2631 // 4. Add back the saved content from the first paragraph. If partialParagraph
2632 // is true, add it to the last paragraph added and not a new one.
2634 // 1. Remove and save objects after split point.
2635 wxList savedObjects
;
2637 para
->MoveToList(nextObject
, savedObjects
);
2639 // 2. Add the content from the 1st fragment paragraph.
2640 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstParaNode
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
2644 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= wxDynamicCast(firstParaNode
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2645 wxASSERT(firstPara
!= NULL
);
2647 if (!(fragment
.GetAttributes().GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_KEEP_FIRST_PARA_STYLE
))
2648 para
->SetAttributes(firstPara
->GetAttributes());
2650 // Save empty paragraph attributes for appending later
2651 // These are character attributes deliberately set for a new paragraph. Without this,
2652 // we couldn't pass default attributes when appending a new paragraph.
2653 wxRichTextAttr emptyParagraphAttributes
;
2655 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator objectNode
= firstPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
2657 if (objectNode
&& firstPara
->GetChildren().GetCount() == 1 && objectNode
->GetData()->IsEmpty())
2658 emptyParagraphAttributes
= objectNode
->GetData()->GetAttributes();
2662 wxRichTextObject
* newObj
= objectNode
->GetData()->Clone();
2665 para
->AppendChild(newObj
);
2667 objectNode
= objectNode
->GetNext();
2670 // 3. Add remaining fragment paragraphs after the current paragraph.
2671 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator nextParagraphNode
= node
->GetNext();
2672 wxRichTextObject
* nextParagraph
= NULL
;
2673 if (nextParagraphNode
)
2674 nextParagraph
= nextParagraphNode
->GetData();
2676 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator i
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetNext();
2677 wxRichTextParagraph
* finalPara
= para
;
2679 bool needExtraPara
= (!i
|| !fragment
.GetPartialParagraph());
2681 // If there was only one paragraph, we need to insert a new one.
2684 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(i
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2685 wxASSERT( para
!= NULL
);
2687 finalPara
= (wxRichTextParagraph
*) para
->Clone();
2690 InsertChild(finalPara
, nextParagraph
);
2692 AppendChild(finalPara
);
2697 // If there was only one paragraph, or we have full paragraphs in our fragment,
2698 // we need to insert a new one.
2701 finalPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph
;
2704 InsertChild(finalPara
, nextParagraph
);
2706 AppendChild(finalPara
);
2709 // 4. Add back the remaining content.
2713 finalPara
->MoveFromList(savedObjects
);
2715 // Ensure there's at least one object
2716 if (finalPara
->GetChildCount() == 0)
2718 wxRichTextPlainText
* text
= new wxRichTextPlainText(wxEmptyString
);
2719 text
->SetAttributes(emptyParagraphAttributes
);
2721 finalPara
->AppendChild(text
);
2725 if ((fragment
.GetAttributes().GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_KEEP_FIRST_PARA_STYLE
) && firstPara
)
2726 finalPara
->SetAttributes(firstPara
->GetAttributes());
2727 else if (finalPara
&& finalPara
!= para
)
2728 finalPara
->SetAttributes(originalAttr
);
2736 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator i
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
2739 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(i
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2740 wxASSERT( para
!= NULL
);
2742 AppendChild(para
->Clone());
2751 /// Make a copy of the fragment corresponding to the given range, putting it in 'fragment'.
2752 /// If there was an incomplete paragraph at the end, partialParagraph is set to true.
2753 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::CopyFragment(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& fragment
)
2755 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator i
= GetChildren().GetFirst();
2758 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(i
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2759 wxASSERT( para
!= NULL
);
2761 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
2763 fragment
.AppendChild(para
->Clone());
2768 // Now top and tail the first and last paragraphs in our new fragment (which might be the same).
2769 if (!fragment
.IsEmpty())
2771 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= wxDynamicCast(fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2772 wxASSERT( firstPara
!= NULL
);
2774 wxRichTextParagraph
* lastPara
= wxDynamicCast(fragment
.GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2775 wxASSERT( lastPara
!= NULL
);
2777 if (!firstPara
|| !lastPara
)
2780 bool isFragment
= (range
.GetEnd() < lastPara
->GetRange().GetEnd());
2782 long firstPos
= firstPara
->GetRange().GetStart();
2784 // Adjust for renumbering from zero
2785 wxRichTextRange
topTailRange(range
.GetStart() - firstPos
, range
.GetEnd() - firstPos
);
2788 fragment
.CalculateRange(0, end
);
2790 // Chop off the start of the paragraph
2791 if (topTailRange
.GetStart() > 0)
2793 wxRichTextRange
r(0, topTailRange
.GetStart()-1);
2794 firstPara
->DeleteRange(r
);
2796 // Make sure the numbering is correct
2797 fragment
.CalculateRange(0, end
);
2799 // Now, we've deleted some positions, so adjust the range
2801 topTailRange
.SetStart(range
.GetLength());
2802 topTailRange
.SetEnd(fragment
.GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
2806 topTailRange
.SetStart(range
.GetLength());
2807 topTailRange
.SetEnd(fragment
.GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
2810 if (topTailRange
.GetStart() < lastPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
2812 lastPara
->DeleteRange(topTailRange
);
2814 // Make sure the numbering is correct
2816 fragment
.CalculateRange(0, end
);
2818 // We only have part of a paragraph at the end
2819 fragment
.SetPartialParagraph(true);
2823 // We have a partial paragraph (don't save last new paragraph marker)
2824 // or complete paragraph
2825 fragment
.SetPartialParagraph(isFragment
);
2832 /// Given a position, get the number of the visible line (potentially many to a paragraph),
2833 /// starting from zero at the start of the buffer.
2834 long wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetVisibleLineNumber(long pos
, bool caretPosition
, bool startOfLine
) const
2841 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2844 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2845 // wxASSERT( child != NULL );
2849 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
2851 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2854 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2855 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
2857 if (lineRange
.Contains(pos
) || pos
== lineRange
.GetStart())
2859 // If the caret is displayed at the end of the previous wrapped line,
2860 // we want to return the line it's _displayed_ at (not the actual line
2861 // containing the position).
2862 if (lineRange
.GetStart() == pos
&& !startOfLine
&& child
->GetRange().GetStart() != pos
)
2863 return lineCount
- 1;
2870 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2872 // If we didn't find it in the lines, it must be
2873 // the last position of the paragraph. So return the last line.
2877 lineCount
+= child
->GetLines().GetCount();
2880 node
= node
->GetNext();
2887 /// Given a line number, get the corresponding wxRichTextLine object.
2888 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineForVisibleLineNumber(long lineNumber
) const
2892 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2895 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2896 // wxASSERT(child != NULL);
2900 if (lineNumber
< (int) (child
->GetLines().GetCount() + lineCount
))
2902 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2905 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2907 if (lineCount
== lineNumber
)
2912 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2916 lineCount
+= child
->GetLines().GetCount();
2919 node
= node
->GetNext();
2926 /// Delete range from layout.
2927 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
2929 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2931 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= NULL
;
2934 wxRichTextParagraph
* obj
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2935 // wxASSERT (obj != NULL);
2937 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
2941 // Delete the range in each paragraph
2943 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
2945 // Deletes the content of this object within the given range
2946 obj
->DeleteRange(range
);
2948 wxRichTextRange thisRange
= obj
->GetRange();
2949 wxRichTextAttr thisAttr
= obj
->GetAttributes();
2951 // If the whole paragraph is within the range to delete,
2952 // delete the whole thing.
2953 if (range
.GetStart() <= thisRange
.GetStart() && range
.GetEnd() >= thisRange
.GetEnd())
2955 // Delete the whole object
2956 RemoveChild(obj
, true);
2959 else if (!firstPara
)
2962 // If the range includes the paragraph end, we need to join this
2963 // and the next paragraph.
2964 if (range
.GetEnd() <= thisRange
.GetEnd())
2966 // We need to move the objects from the next paragraph
2967 // to this paragraph
2969 wxRichTextParagraph
* nextParagraph
= NULL
;
2970 if ((range
.GetEnd() < thisRange
.GetEnd()) && obj
)
2971 nextParagraph
= obj
;
2974 // We're ending at the end of the paragraph, so merge the _next_ paragraph.
2976 nextParagraph
= wxDynamicCast(next
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2979 bool applyFinalParagraphStyle
= firstPara
&& nextParagraph
&& nextParagraph
!= firstPara
;
2981 wxRichTextAttr nextParaAttr
;
2982 if (applyFinalParagraphStyle
)
2984 // Special case when deleting the end of a paragraph - use _this_ paragraph's style,
2985 // not the next one.
2986 if (range
.GetStart() == range
.GetEnd() && range
.GetStart() == thisRange
.GetEnd())
2987 nextParaAttr
= thisAttr
;
2989 nextParaAttr
= nextParagraph
->GetAttributes();
2992 if (firstPara
&& nextParagraph
&& firstPara
!= nextParagraph
)
2994 // Move the objects to the previous para
2995 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node1
= nextParagraph
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
2999 wxRichTextObject
* obj1
= node1
->GetData();
3001 firstPara
->AppendChild(obj1
);
3003 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next1
= node1
->GetNext();
3004 nextParagraph
->GetChildren().Erase(node1
);
3009 // Delete the paragraph
3010 RemoveChild(nextParagraph
, true);
3013 // Avoid empty paragraphs
3014 if (firstPara
&& firstPara
->GetChildren().GetCount() == 0)
3016 wxRichTextPlainText
* text
= new wxRichTextPlainText(wxEmptyString
);
3017 firstPara
->AppendChild(text
);
3020 if (applyFinalParagraphStyle
)
3021 firstPara
->SetAttributes(nextParaAttr
);
3034 /// Get any text in this object for the given range
3035 wxString
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
3039 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3042 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
3043 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3045 wxRichTextRange childRange
= range
;
3046 childRange
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
3048 wxString childText
= child
->GetTextForRange(childRange
);
3052 if ((childRange
.GetEnd() == child
->GetRange().GetEnd()) && node
->GetNext())
3057 node
= node
->GetNext();
3063 /// Get all the text
3064 wxString
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetText() const
3066 return GetTextForRange(GetOwnRange());
3069 /// Get the paragraph by number
3070 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphAtLine(long paragraphNumber
) const
3072 if ((size_t) paragraphNumber
>= GetChildCount())
3075 return (wxRichTextParagraph
*) GetChild((size_t) paragraphNumber
);
3078 /// Get the length of the paragraph
3079 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphLength(long paragraphNumber
) const
3081 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtLine(paragraphNumber
);
3083 return para
->GetRange().GetLength() - 1; // don't include newline
3088 /// Get the text of the paragraph
3089 wxString
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphText(long paragraphNumber
) const
3091 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtLine(paragraphNumber
);
3093 return para
->GetTextForRange(para
->GetRange());
3095 return wxEmptyString
;
3098 /// Convert zero-based line column and paragraph number to a position.
3099 long wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::XYToPosition(long x
, long y
) const
3101 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtLine(y
);
3104 return para
->GetRange().GetStart() + x
;
3110 /// Convert zero-based position to line column and paragraph number
3111 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::PositionToXY(long pos
, long* x
, long* y
) const
3113 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(pos
);
3117 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3120 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
3124 node
= node
->GetNext();
3128 *x
= pos
- para
->GetRange().GetStart();
3136 /// Get the leaf object in a paragraph at this position.
3137 /// Given a line number, get the corresponding wxRichTextLine object.
3138 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLeafObjectAtPosition(long position
) const
3140 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(position
);
3143 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
3147 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
3148 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(position
))
3151 node
= node
->GetNext();
3153 if (position
== para
->GetRange().GetEnd() && para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
3154 return para
->GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData();
3159 /// Set character or paragraph text attributes: apply character styles only to immediate text nodes
3160 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, int flags
)
3162 bool characterStyle
= false;
3163 bool paragraphStyle
= false;
3165 if (style
.IsCharacterStyle())
3166 characterStyle
= true;
3167 if (style
.IsParagraphStyle())
3168 paragraphStyle
= true;
3170 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3172 bool withUndo
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
3173 bool applyMinimal
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_OPTIMIZE
) != 0);
3174 bool parasOnly
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_PARAGRAPHS_ONLY
) != 0);
3175 bool charactersOnly
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_CHARACTERS_ONLY
) != 0);
3176 bool resetExistingStyle
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
) != 0);
3177 bool removeStyle
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_REMOVE
) != 0);
3179 // Apply paragraph style first, if any
3180 wxRichTextAttr
wholeStyle(style
);
3182 if (!removeStyle
&& wholeStyle
.HasParagraphStyleName() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
3184 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(wholeStyle
.GetParagraphStyleName());
3186 wxRichTextApplyStyle(wholeStyle
, def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet()));
3189 // Limit the attributes to be set to the content to only character attributes.
3190 wxRichTextAttr
characterAttributes(wholeStyle
);
3191 characterAttributes
.SetFlags(characterAttributes
.GetFlags() & (wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER
));
3193 if (!removeStyle
&& characterAttributes
.HasCharacterStyleName() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
3195 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindCharacterStyle(characterAttributes
.GetCharacterStyleName());
3197 wxRichTextApplyStyle(characterAttributes
, def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet()));
3200 // If we are associated with a control, make undoable; otherwise, apply immediately
3203 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
3205 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
3207 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3209 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change Style"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3210 action
->SetRange(range
);
3211 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
3214 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3217 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3218 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3220 if (para
&& para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
3222 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3223 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3226 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3228 // We'll be using a copy of the paragraph to make style changes,
3229 // not updating the buffer directly.
3230 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3232 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3234 newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
3235 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
3237 // Also store the old ones for Undo
3238 action
->GetOldParagraphs().AppendChild(new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
));
3243 // If we're specifying paragraphs only, then we really mean character formatting
3244 // to be included in the paragraph style
3245 if ((paragraphStyle
|| parasOnly
) && !charactersOnly
)
3249 // Removes the given style from the paragraph
3250 wxRichTextRemoveStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), style
);
3252 else if (resetExistingStyle
)
3253 newPara
->GetAttributes() = wholeStyle
;
3258 // Only apply attributes that will make a difference to the combined
3259 // style as seen on the display
3260 wxRichTextAttr
combinedAttr(para
->GetCombinedAttributes(true));
3261 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), wholeStyle
, & combinedAttr
);
3264 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), wholeStyle
);
3268 // When applying paragraph styles dynamically, don't change the text objects' attributes
3269 // since they will computed as needed. Only apply the character styling if it's _only_
3270 // character styling. This policy is subject to change and might be put under user control.
3272 // Hm. we might well be applying a mix of paragraph and character styles, in which
3273 // case we _do_ want to apply character styles regardless of what para styles are set.
3274 // But if we're applying a paragraph style, which has some character attributes, but
3275 // we only want the paragraphs to hold this character style, then we _don't_ want to
3276 // apply the character style. So we need to be able to choose.
3278 if (!parasOnly
&& (characterStyle
|charactersOnly
) && range
.GetStart() != newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3280 wxRichTextRange
childRange(range
);
3281 childRange
.LimitTo(newPara
->GetRange());
3283 // Find the starting position and if necessary split it so
3284 // we can start applying a different style.
3285 // TODO: check that the style actually changes or is different
3286 // from style outside of range
3287 wxRichTextObject
* firstObject
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3288 wxRichTextObject
* lastObject
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3290 if (childRange
.GetStart() == newPara
->GetRange().GetStart())
3291 firstObject
= newPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
3293 firstObject
= newPara
->SplitAt(range
.GetStart());
3295 // Increment by 1 because we're apply the style one _after_ the split point
3296 long splitPoint
= childRange
.GetEnd();
3297 if (splitPoint
!= newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3301 if (splitPoint
== newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3302 lastObject
= newPara
->GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData();
3304 // lastObject is set as a side-effect of splitting. It's
3305 // returned as the object before the new object.
3306 (void) newPara
->SplitAt(splitPoint
, & lastObject
);
3308 wxASSERT(firstObject
!= NULL
);
3309 wxASSERT(lastObject
!= NULL
);
3311 if (!firstObject
|| !lastObject
)
3314 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstNode
= newPara
->GetChildren().Find(firstObject
);
3315 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator lastNode
= newPara
->GetChildren().Find(lastObject
);
3317 wxASSERT(firstNode
);
3320 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= firstNode
;
3324 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
3328 // Removes the given style from the paragraph
3329 wxRichTextRemoveStyle(child
->GetAttributes(), style
);
3331 else if (resetExistingStyle
)
3333 // Preserve the URL as it's not really a formatting style but a property of the object
3335 if (child
->GetAttributes().HasURL() && !characterAttributes
.HasURL())
3336 url
= child
->GetAttributes().GetURL();
3338 child
->GetAttributes() = characterAttributes
;
3341 child
->GetAttributes().SetURL(url
);
3347 // Only apply attributes that will make a difference to the combined
3348 // style as seen on the display
3349 wxRichTextAttr
combinedAttr(newPara
->GetCombinedAttributes(child
->GetAttributes(), true));
3350 wxRichTextApplyStyle(child
->GetAttributes(), characterAttributes
, & combinedAttr
);
3353 wxRichTextApplyStyle(child
->GetAttributes(), characterAttributes
);
3356 if (node2
== lastNode
)
3359 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
3365 node
= node
->GetNext();
3368 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
3369 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3370 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
3375 // Just change the attributes for this single object.
3376 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetStyle(wxRichTextObject
* obj
, const wxRichTextAttr
& textAttr
, int flags
)
3378 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3379 bool withUndo
= flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
;
3380 bool resetExistingStyle
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
) != 0);
3381 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
3383 wxRichTextAction
*action
= NULL
;
3384 wxRichTextAttr newAttr
= obj
->GetAttributes();
3385 if (resetExistingStyle
)
3388 newAttr
.Apply(textAttr
);
3390 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3392 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change Object Style"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES
, buffer
, obj
->GetContainer(), buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3393 action
->SetRange(obj
->GetRange().FromInternal());
3394 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
3395 action
->MakeObject(obj
);
3397 action
->GetAttributes() = newAttr
;
3400 obj
->GetAttributes() = newAttr
;
3402 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3403 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
3406 /// Get the text attributes for this position.
3407 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyle(long position
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3409 return DoGetStyle(position
, style
, true);
3412 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetUncombinedStyle(long position
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3414 return DoGetStyle(position
, style
, false);
3417 /// Implementation helper for GetStyle. If combineStyles is true, combine base, paragraph and
3418 /// context attributes.
3419 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DoGetStyle(long position
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
, bool combineStyles
)
3421 wxRichTextObject
* obj
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3423 if (style
.IsParagraphStyle())
3425 obj
= GetParagraphAtPosition(position
);
3430 // Start with the base style
3431 style
= GetAttributes();
3432 style
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
3434 // Apply the paragraph style
3435 wxRichTextApplyStyle(style
, obj
->GetAttributes());
3438 style
= obj
->GetAttributes();
3445 obj
= GetLeafObjectAtPosition(position
);
3450 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(obj
->GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3451 style
= para
? para
->GetCombinedAttributes(obj
->GetAttributes()) : obj
->GetAttributes();
3454 style
= obj
->GetAttributes();
3462 static bool wxHasStyle(long flags
, long style
)
3464 return (flags
& style
) != 0;
3467 /// Combines 'style' with 'currentStyle' for the purpose of summarising the attributes of a range of
3469 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::CollectStyle(wxRichTextAttr
& currentStyle
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, wxRichTextAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxRichTextAttr
& absentAttr
)
3471 currentStyle
.CollectCommonAttributes(style
, clashingAttr
, absentAttr
);
3476 /// Get the combined style for a range - if any attribute is different within the range,
3477 /// that attribute is not present within the flags.
3478 /// *** Note that this is not recursive, and so assumes that content inside a paragraph is not itself
3480 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyleForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3482 style
= wxRichTextAttr();
3484 wxRichTextAttr clashingAttrPara
, clashingAttrChar
;
3485 wxRichTextAttr absentAttrPara
, absentAttrChar
;
3487 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= GetChildren().GetFirst();
3490 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3491 if (para
&& !(para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd() || para
->GetRange().GetEnd() < range
.GetStart()))
3493 if (para
->GetChildren().GetCount() == 0)
3495 wxRichTextAttr paraStyle
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(true /* use box attributes */);
3497 CollectStyle(style
, paraStyle
, clashingAttrPara
, absentAttrPara
);
3501 wxRichTextRange
paraRange(para
->GetRange());
3502 paraRange
.LimitTo(range
);
3504 // First collect paragraph attributes only
3505 wxRichTextAttr paraStyle
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes();
3506 paraStyle
.SetFlags(paraStyle
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH
);
3507 CollectStyle(style
, paraStyle
, clashingAttrPara
, absentAttrPara
);
3509 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator childNode
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
3513 wxRichTextObject
* child
= childNode
->GetData();
3514 if (!(child
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd() || child
->GetRange().GetEnd() < range
.GetStart()))
3516 wxRichTextAttr childStyle
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(child
->GetAttributes(), true /* include box attributes */);
3518 // Now collect character attributes only
3519 childStyle
.SetFlags(childStyle
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER
);
3521 CollectStyle(style
, childStyle
, clashingAttrChar
, absentAttrChar
);
3524 childNode
= childNode
->GetNext();
3528 node
= node
->GetNext();
3533 /// Set default style
3534 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetDefaultStyle(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3536 m_defaultAttributes
= style
;
3540 /// Test if this whole range has character attributes of the specified kind. If any
3541 /// of the attributes are different within the range, the test fails. You
3542 /// can use this to implement, for example, bold button updating. style must have
3543 /// flags indicating which attributes are of interest.
3544 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HasCharacterAttributes(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
) const
3547 int matchingCount
= 0;
3549 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3552 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3553 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3557 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3558 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3559 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3561 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3563 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
3567 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
3568 // Allow for empty string if no buffer
3569 wxRichTextRange childRange
= child
->GetRange();
3570 if (childRange
.GetLength() == 0 && GetRange().GetLength() == 1)
3571 childRange
.SetEnd(childRange
.GetEnd()+1);
3573 if (!childRange
.IsOutside(range
) && wxDynamicCast(child
, wxRichTextPlainText
))
3576 wxRichTextAttr textAttr
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(child
->GetAttributes());
3578 if (textAttr
.EqPartial(style
, false /* strong test - attributes must be valid in both objects */))
3582 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
3587 node
= node
->GetNext();
3590 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3593 /// Test if this whole range has paragraph attributes of the specified kind. If any
3594 /// of the attributes are different within the range, the test fails. You
3595 /// can use this to implement, for example, centering button updating. style must have
3596 /// flags indicating which attributes are of interest.
3597 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HasParagraphAttributes(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
) const
3600 int matchingCount
= 0;
3602 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3605 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3606 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3610 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3611 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3612 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3614 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3616 wxRichTextAttr textAttr
= GetAttributes();
3617 // Apply the paragraph style
3618 wxRichTextApplyStyle(textAttr
, para
->GetAttributes());
3621 if (textAttr
.EqPartial(style
, false /* strong test */))
3626 node
= node
->GetNext();
3628 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3631 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::PrepareContent(wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& container
)
3633 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3634 if (buffer
&& buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl())
3635 buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->PrepareContent(container
);
3638 /// Set character or paragraph properties
3639 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetProperties(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextProperties
& properties
, int flags
)
3641 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3643 bool withUndo
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETPROPERTIES_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
3644 bool parasOnly
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETPROPERTIES_PARAGRAPHS_ONLY
) != 0);
3645 bool charactersOnly
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETPROPERTIES_CHARACTERS_ONLY
) != 0);
3646 bool resetExistingProperties
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETPROPERTIES_RESET
) != 0);
3647 bool removeProperties
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETPROPERTIES_REMOVE
) != 0);
3649 // If we are associated with a control, make undoable; otherwise, apply immediately
3652 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
3654 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
3656 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3658 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change Properties"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_PROPERTIES
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3659 action
->SetRange(range
);
3660 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
3663 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3666 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3667 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3669 if (para
&& para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
3671 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3672 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3675 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3677 // We'll be using a copy of the paragraph to make style changes,
3678 // not updating the buffer directly.
3679 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3681 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3683 newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
3684 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
3686 // Also store the old ones for Undo
3687 action
->GetOldParagraphs().AppendChild(new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
));
3694 if (removeProperties
)
3696 // Removes the given style from the paragraph
3698 newPara
->GetProperties().RemoveProperties(properties
);
3700 else if (resetExistingProperties
)
3701 newPara
->GetProperties() = properties
;
3703 newPara
->GetProperties().MergeProperties(properties
);
3706 // When applying paragraph styles dynamically, don't change the text objects' attributes
3707 // since they will computed as needed. Only apply the character styling if it's _only_
3708 // character styling. This policy is subject to change and might be put under user control.
3710 // Hm. we might well be applying a mix of paragraph and character styles, in which
3711 // case we _do_ want to apply character styles regardless of what para styles are set.
3712 // But if we're applying a paragraph style, which has some character attributes, but
3713 // we only want the paragraphs to hold this character style, then we _don't_ want to
3714 // apply the character style. So we need to be able to choose.
3716 if (!parasOnly
&& charactersOnly
&& range
.GetStart() != newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3718 wxRichTextRange
childRange(range
);
3719 childRange
.LimitTo(newPara
->GetRange());
3721 // Find the starting position and if necessary split it so
3722 // we can start applying different properties.
3723 // TODO: check that the properties actually change or are different
3724 // from properties outside of range
3725 wxRichTextObject
* firstObject
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3726 wxRichTextObject
* lastObject
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3728 if (childRange
.GetStart() == newPara
->GetRange().GetStart())
3729 firstObject
= newPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
3731 firstObject
= newPara
->SplitAt(range
.GetStart());
3733 // Increment by 1 because we're apply the style one _after_ the split point
3734 long splitPoint
= childRange
.GetEnd();
3735 if (splitPoint
!= newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3739 if (splitPoint
== newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3740 lastObject
= newPara
->GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData();
3742 // lastObject is set as a side-effect of splitting. It's
3743 // returned as the object before the new object.
3744 (void) newPara
->SplitAt(splitPoint
, & lastObject
);
3746 wxASSERT(firstObject
!= NULL
);
3747 wxASSERT(lastObject
!= NULL
);
3749 if (!firstObject
|| !lastObject
)
3752 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstNode
= newPara
->GetChildren().Find(firstObject
);
3753 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator lastNode
= newPara
->GetChildren().Find(lastObject
);
3755 wxASSERT(firstNode
);
3758 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= firstNode
;
3762 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
3764 if (removeProperties
)
3766 // Removes the given properties from the paragraph
3767 child
->GetProperties().RemoveProperties(properties
);
3769 else if (resetExistingProperties
)
3770 child
->GetProperties() = properties
;
3773 child
->GetProperties().MergeProperties(properties
);
3776 if (node2
== lastNode
)
3779 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
3785 node
= node
->GetNext();
3788 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
3789 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3790 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
3795 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Reset()
3799 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3800 if (buffer
&& buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl())
3802 wxRichTextEvent
event(wxEVT_RICHTEXT_BUFFER_RESET
, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetId());
3803 event
.SetEventObject(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3804 event
.SetContainer(this);
3806 buffer
->SendEvent(event
, true);
3809 AddParagraph(wxEmptyString
);
3811 PrepareContent(*this);
3813 InvalidateHierarchy(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
3816 /// Invalidate the buffer. With no argument, invalidates whole buffer.
3817 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Invalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
3819 wxRichTextCompositeObject::Invalidate(invalidRange
);
3821 DoInvalidate(invalidRange
);
3824 // Do the (in)validation for this object only
3825 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DoInvalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
3827 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
)
3829 m_invalidRange
= wxRICHTEXT_ALL
;
3831 // Already invalidating everything
3832 else if (m_invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
)
3837 if ((invalidRange
.GetStart() < m_invalidRange
.GetStart()) || m_invalidRange
.GetStart() == -1)
3838 m_invalidRange
.SetStart(invalidRange
.GetStart());
3839 if (invalidRange
.GetEnd() > m_invalidRange
.GetEnd())
3840 m_invalidRange
.SetEnd(invalidRange
.GetEnd());
3844 // Do the (in)validation both up and down the hierarchy
3845 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InvalidateHierarchy(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
3847 Invalidate(invalidRange
);
3849 if (invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
3851 // Now go up the hierarchy
3852 wxRichTextObject
* thisObj
= this;
3853 wxRichTextObject
* p
= GetParent();
3856 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* l
= wxDynamicCast(p
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
3858 l
->DoInvalidate(thisObj
->GetRange());
3866 /// Get invalid range, rounding to entire paragraphs if argument is true.
3867 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetInvalidRange(bool wholeParagraphs
) const
3869 if (m_invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| m_invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
3870 return m_invalidRange
;
3872 wxRichTextRange range
= m_invalidRange
;
3874 if (wholeParagraphs
)
3876 wxRichTextParagraph
* para1
= GetParagraphAtPosition(range
.GetStart());
3878 range
.SetStart(para1
->GetRange().GetStart());
3880 // FIXME: be more intelligent about this. Check if we have floating objects
3881 // before the end of the range. But it's not clear how we can in general
3882 // tell where it's safe to stop laying out.
3883 // Anyway, this code is central to efficiency when laying in floating mode.
3884 if (!wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
3886 wxRichTextParagraph
* para2
= GetParagraphAtPosition(range
.GetEnd());
3888 range
.SetEnd(para2
->GetRange().GetEnd());
3891 // Floating layout means that all children should be laid out,
3892 // because we can't tell how the whole buffer will be affected.
3893 range
.SetEnd(GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
3898 /// Apply the style sheet to the buffer, for example if the styles have changed.
3899 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::ApplyStyleSheet(wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
)
3901 wxASSERT(styleSheet
!= NULL
);
3907 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetBasicStyle());
3908 if (GetBasicStyle().HasParagraphStyleName())
3910 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* paraDef
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(GetBasicStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
3913 attr
.Apply(paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
));
3914 SetBasicStyle(attr
);
3919 if (GetBasicStyle().HasCharacterStyleName())
3921 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* charDef
= styleSheet
->FindCharacterStyle(GetBasicStyle().GetCharacterStyleName());
3924 attr
.Apply(charDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
));
3925 SetBasicStyle(attr
);
3930 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3933 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3934 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3938 // Combine paragraph and list styles. If there is a list style in the original attributes,
3939 // the current indentation overrides anything else and is used to find the item indentation.
3940 // Also, for applying paragraph styles, consider having 2 modes: (1) we merge with what we have,
3941 // thereby taking into account all user changes, (2) reset the style completely (except for indentation/list
3942 // exception as above).
3943 // Problem: when changing from one list style to another, there's a danger that the level info will get lost.
3944 // So when changing a list style interactively, could retrieve level based on current style, then
3945 // set appropriate indent and apply new style.
3949 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasOutlineLevel())
3950 outline
= para
->GetAttributes().GetOutlineLevel();
3951 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
3952 num
= para
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber();
3954 if (!para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && !para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3956 int currentIndent
= para
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
3958 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* paraDef
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
3959 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* listDef
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
3960 if (paraDef
&& !listDef
)
3962 para
->GetAttributes() = paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3965 else if (listDef
&& !paraDef
)
3967 // Set overall style defined for the list style definition
3968 para
->GetAttributes() = listDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3970 // Apply the style for this level
3971 wxRichTextApplyStyle(para
->GetAttributes(), * listDef
->GetLevelAttributes(listDef
->FindLevelForIndent(currentIndent
)));
3974 else if (listDef
&& paraDef
)
3976 // Combines overall list style, style for level, and paragraph style
3977 para
->GetAttributes() = listDef
->CombineWithParagraphStyle(currentIndent
, paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
));
3981 else if (para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && !para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3983 int currentIndent
= para
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
3985 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* listDef
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
3987 // Overall list definition style
3988 para
->GetAttributes() = listDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3990 // Style for this level
3991 wxRichTextApplyStyle(para
->GetAttributes(), * listDef
->GetLevelAttributes(listDef
->FindLevelForIndent(currentIndent
)));
3995 else if (!para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3997 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
4000 para
->GetAttributes() = def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
4006 para
->GetAttributes().SetOutlineLevel(outline
);
4008 para
->GetAttributes().SetBulletNumber(num
);
4011 node
= node
->GetNext();
4013 return foundCount
!= 0;
4017 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetListStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
4019 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4020 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet();
4022 bool withUndo
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
4023 // bool applyMinimal = ((flags & wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_OPTIMIZE) != 0);
4024 bool specifyLevel
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_SPECIFY_LEVEL
) != 0);
4025 bool renumber
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RENUMBER
) != 0);
4027 // Current number, if numbering
4030 wxASSERT (!specifyLevel
|| (specifyLevel
&& (specifiedLevel
>= 0)));
4032 // If we are associated with a control, make undoable; otherwise, apply immediately
4035 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
4037 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
4039 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
4041 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change List Style"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
4042 action
->SetRange(range
);
4043 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
4046 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4049 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
4050 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
4052 if (para
&& para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
4054 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
4055 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
4058 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
4060 // We'll be using a copy of the paragraph to make style changes,
4061 // not updating the buffer directly.
4062 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
4064 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
4066 newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
4067 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
4069 // Also store the old ones for Undo
4070 action
->GetOldParagraphs().AppendChild(new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
));
4077 int thisIndent
= newPara
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
4078 int thisLevel
= specifyLevel
? specifiedLevel
: def
->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent
);
4080 // How is numbering going to work?
4081 // If we are renumbering, or numbering for the first time, we need to keep
4082 // track of the number for each level. But we might be simply applying a different
4084 // In Word, applying a style to several paragraphs, even if at different levels,
4085 // reverts the level back to the same one. So we could do the same here.
4086 // Renumbering will need to be done when we promote/demote a paragraph.
4088 // Apply the overall list style, and item style for this level
4089 wxRichTextAttr
listStyle(def
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(thisLevel
, styleSheet
));
4090 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), listStyle
);
4092 // Now we need to do numbering
4093 // Preserve the existing list item continuation bullet style, if any
4094 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasBulletStyle() && (para
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_CONTINUATION
))
4095 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle()|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_CONTINUATION
);
4100 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletNumber(n
);
4106 else if (!newPara
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
4108 // if def is NULL, remove list style, applying any associated paragraph style
4109 // to restore the attributes
4111 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetListStyleName(wxEmptyString
);
4112 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetLeftIndent(0, 0);
4113 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletText(wxEmptyString
);
4114 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletStyle(0);
4116 // Eliminate the main list-related attributes
4117 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetFlags(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
& ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
& ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
& ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
& wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
4119 if (styleSheet
&& !newPara
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty())
4121 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
4124 newPara
->GetAttributes() = def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
4131 node
= node
->GetNext();
4134 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
4135 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
4136 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
4141 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetListStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxString
& defName
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
4143 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4144 if (buffer
&& buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
4146 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(defName
);
4148 return SetListStyle(range
, def
, flags
, startFrom
, specifiedLevel
);
4153 /// Clear list for given range
4154 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::ClearListStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, int flags
)
4156 return SetListStyle(range
, NULL
, flags
);
4159 /// Number/renumber any list elements in the given range
4160 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::NumberList(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
4162 return DoNumberList(range
, range
, 0, def
, flags
, startFrom
, specifiedLevel
);
4165 /// Number/renumber any list elements in the given range. Also do promotion or demotion of items, if specified
4166 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DoNumberList(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextRange
& promotionRange
, int promoteBy
,
4167 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
4169 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4170 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet();
4172 bool withUndo
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
4173 // bool applyMinimal = ((flags & wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_OPTIMIZE) != 0);
4175 bool specifyLevel
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_SPECIFY_LEVEL
) != 0);
4178 bool renumber
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RENUMBER
) != 0);
4180 // Max number of levels
4181 const int maxLevels
= 10;
4183 // The level we're looking at now
4184 int currentLevel
= -1;
4186 // The item number for each level
4187 int levels
[maxLevels
];
4190 // Reset all numbering
4191 for (i
= 0; i
< maxLevels
; i
++)
4193 if (startFrom
!= -1)
4194 levels
[i
] = startFrom
-1;
4195 else if (renumber
) // start again
4198 levels
[i
] = -1; // start from the number we found, if any
4202 wxASSERT(!specifyLevel
|| (specifyLevel
&& (specifiedLevel
>= 0)));
4205 // If we are associated with a control, make undoable; otherwise, apply immediately
4208 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
4210 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
4212 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
4214 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Renumber List"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
4215 action
->SetRange(range
);
4216 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
4219 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4222 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
4223 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
4225 if (para
&& para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
4227 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
4228 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
4231 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
4233 // We'll be using a copy of the paragraph to make style changes,
4234 // not updating the buffer directly.
4235 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
4237 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
4239 newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
4240 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
4242 // Also store the old ones for Undo
4243 action
->GetOldParagraphs().AppendChild(new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
));
4248 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* defToUse
= def
;
4251 if (styleSheet
&& !newPara
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
4252 defToUse
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
4257 int thisIndent
= newPara
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
4258 int thisLevel
= defToUse
->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent
);
4260 // If we've specified a level to apply to all, change the level.
4261 if (specifiedLevel
!= -1)
4262 thisLevel
= specifiedLevel
;
4264 // Do promotion if specified
4265 if ((promoteBy
!= 0) && !para
->GetRange().IsOutside(promotionRange
))
4267 thisLevel
= thisLevel
- promoteBy
;
4274 // Apply the overall list style, and item style for this level
4275 wxRichTextAttr
listStyle(defToUse
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(thisLevel
, styleSheet
));
4276 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), listStyle
);
4278 // Preserve the existing list item continuation bullet style, if any
4279 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasBulletStyle() && (para
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_CONTINUATION
))
4280 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle()|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_CONTINUATION
);
4282 // OK, we've (re)applied the style, now let's get the numbering right.
4284 if (currentLevel
== -1)
4285 currentLevel
= thisLevel
;
4287 // Same level as before, do nothing except increment level's number afterwards
4288 if (currentLevel
== thisLevel
)
4291 // A deeper level: start renumbering all levels after current level
4292 else if (thisLevel
> currentLevel
)
4294 for (i
= currentLevel
+1; i
<= thisLevel
; i
++)
4298 currentLevel
= thisLevel
;
4300 else if (thisLevel
< currentLevel
)
4302 currentLevel
= thisLevel
;
4305 // Use the current numbering if -1 and we have a bullet number already
4306 if (levels
[currentLevel
] == -1)
4308 if (newPara
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
4309 levels
[currentLevel
] = newPara
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber();
4311 levels
[currentLevel
] = 1;
4315 if (!(para
->GetAttributes().HasBulletStyle() && (para
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_CONTINUATION
)))
4316 levels
[currentLevel
] ++;
4319 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletNumber(levels
[currentLevel
]);
4321 // Create the bullet text if an outline list
4322 if (listStyle
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
)
4325 for (i
= 0; i
<= currentLevel
; i
++)
4327 if (!text
.IsEmpty())
4329 text
+= wxString::Format(wxT("%d"), levels
[i
]);
4331 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletText(text
);
4337 node
= node
->GetNext();
4340 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
4341 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
4342 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
4347 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::NumberList(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxString
& defName
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
4349 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4350 if (buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
4352 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= NULL
;
4353 if (!defName
.IsEmpty())
4354 def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(defName
);
4355 return NumberList(range
, def
, flags
, startFrom
, specifiedLevel
);
4360 /// Promote the list items within the given range. promoteBy can be a positive or negative number, e.g. 1 or -1
4361 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::PromoteList(int promoteBy
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int specifiedLevel
)
4364 // One strategy is to first work out the range within which renumbering must occur. Then could pass these two ranges
4365 // to NumberList with a flag indicating promotion is required within one of the ranges.
4366 // Find first and last paragraphs in range. Then for first, calculate new indentation and look back until we find
4367 // a paragraph that either has no list style, or has one that is different or whose indentation is less.
4368 // We start renumbering from the para after that different para we found. We specify that the numbering of that
4369 // list position will start from 1.
4370 // Similarly, we look after the last para in the promote range for an indentation that is less (or no list style).
4371 // We can end the renumbering at this point.
4373 // For now, only renumber within the promotion range.
4375 return DoNumberList(range
, range
, promoteBy
, def
, flags
, 1, specifiedLevel
);
4378 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::PromoteList(int promoteBy
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxString
& defName
, int flags
, int specifiedLevel
)
4380 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4381 if (buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
4383 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= NULL
;
4384 if (!defName
.IsEmpty())
4385 def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(defName
);
4386 return PromoteList(promoteBy
, range
, def
, flags
, specifiedLevel
);
4391 /// Fills in the attributes for numbering a paragraph after previousParagraph. It also finds the
4392 /// position of the paragraph that it had to start looking from.
4393 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::FindNextParagraphNumber(wxRichTextParagraph
* previousParagraph
, wxRichTextAttr
& attr
) const
4395 // TODO: add GetNextChild/GetPreviousChild to composite
4396 // Search for a paragraph that isn't a continuation paragraph (no bullet)
4397 while (previousParagraph
&& previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().HasBulletStyle() && previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_CONTINUATION
)
4399 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= ((wxRichTextCompositeObject
*) previousParagraph
->GetParent())->GetChildren().Find(previousParagraph
);
4402 node
= node
->GetPrevious();
4404 previousParagraph
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
4406 previousParagraph
= NULL
;
4409 previousParagraph
= NULL
;
4412 if (!previousParagraph
|| !previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().HasFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
) || previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() == wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
)
4415 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4416 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet();
4417 if (styleSheet
&& !previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
4419 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
4422 // int thisIndent = previousParagraph->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
4423 // int thisLevel = def->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent);
4425 bool isOutline
= (previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
) != 0;
4427 attr
.SetFlags(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetFlags() & (wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
));
4428 if (previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().HasBulletName())
4429 attr
.SetBulletName(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletName());
4430 attr
.SetBulletStyle(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle());
4431 attr
.SetListStyleName(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
4433 int nextNumber
= previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber() + 1;
4434 attr
.SetBulletNumber(nextNumber
);
4438 wxString text
= previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletText();
4439 if (!text
.IsEmpty())
4441 int pos
= text
.Find(wxT('.'), true);
4442 if (pos
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
4444 text
= text
.Mid(0, text
.Length() - pos
- 1);
4447 text
= wxEmptyString
;
4448 if (!text
.IsEmpty())
4450 text
+= wxString::Format(wxT("%d"), nextNumber
);
4451 attr
.SetBulletText(text
);
4465 * wxRichTextParagraph
4466 * This object represents a single paragraph (or in a straight text editor, a line).
4469 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextParagraph
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
)
4471 wxArrayInt
wxRichTextParagraph::sm_defaultTabs
;
4473 wxRichTextParagraph::wxRichTextParagraph(wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* style
):
4474 wxRichTextCompositeObject(parent
)
4477 SetAttributes(*style
);
4480 wxRichTextParagraph::wxRichTextParagraph(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
, wxRichTextAttr
* charStyle
):
4481 wxRichTextCompositeObject(parent
)
4484 SetAttributes(*paraStyle
);
4486 AppendChild(new wxRichTextPlainText(text
, this, charStyle
));
4489 wxRichTextParagraph::~wxRichTextParagraph()
4495 bool wxRichTextParagraph::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int WXUNUSED(descent
), int style
)
4500 // Currently we don't merge these attributes with the parent, but we
4501 // should consider whether we should (e.g. if we set a border colour
4502 // for all paragraphs). But generally box attributes are likely to be
4503 // different for different objects.
4504 wxRect paraRect
= GetRect();
4505 wxRichTextAttr attr
= GetCombinedAttributes();
4506 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, this);
4508 DrawBoxAttributes(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, paraRect
);
4510 // Draw the bullet, if any
4511 if ((attr
.GetBulletStyle() == wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
) == 0 && (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_CONTINUATION
) == 0)
4513 if (attr
.GetLeftSubIndent() != 0)
4515 int spaceBeforePara
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore());
4516 int leftIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetLeftIndent());
4518 wxRichTextAttr
bulletAttr(attr
);
4520 // Combine with the font of the first piece of content, if one is specified
4521 if (GetChildren().GetCount() > 0)
4523 wxRichTextObject
* firstObj
= (wxRichTextObject
*) GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
4524 if (!firstObj
->IsFloatable() && firstObj
->GetAttributes().HasFont())
4526 wxRichTextApplyStyle(bulletAttr
, firstObj
->GetAttributes());
4530 // Get line height from first line, if any
4531 wxRichTextLine
* line
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst() ? (wxRichTextLine
* ) m_cachedLines
.GetFirst()->GetData() : NULL
;
4534 int lineHeight
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(0);
4537 lineHeight
= line
->GetSize().y
;
4538 linePos
= line
->GetPosition() + GetPosition();
4543 if (bulletAttr
.HasFont() && GetBuffer())
4544 font
= GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(bulletAttr
);
4546 font
= (*wxNORMAL_FONT
);
4548 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
4550 lineHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
4551 linePos
= GetPosition();
4552 linePos
.y
+= spaceBeforePara
;
4555 wxRect
bulletRect(GetPosition().x
+ leftIndent
, linePos
.y
, linePos
.x
- (GetPosition().x
+ leftIndent
), lineHeight
);
4557 if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_BITMAP
)
4559 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer())
4560 wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer()->DrawBitmapBullet(this, dc
, bulletAttr
, bulletRect
);
4562 else if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_STANDARD
)
4564 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer())
4565 wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer()->DrawStandardBullet(this, dc
, bulletAttr
, bulletRect
);
4569 wxString bulletText
= GetBulletText();
4571 if (!bulletText
.empty() && wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer())
4572 wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer()->DrawTextBullet(this, dc
, bulletAttr
, bulletRect
, bulletText
);
4577 // Draw the range for each line, one object at a time.
4579 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
4582 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
4583 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
4585 // Lines are specified relative to the paragraph
4587 wxPoint linePosition
= line
->GetPosition() + GetPosition();
4589 // Don't draw if off the screen
4590 if (((style
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_IGNORE_CACHE
) != 0) || ((linePosition
.y
+ line
->GetSize().y
) >= rect
.y
&& linePosition
.y
<= rect
.y
+ rect
.height
))
4592 wxPoint objectPosition
= linePosition
;
4593 int maxDescent
= line
->GetDescent();
4595 // Loop through objects until we get to the one within range
4596 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4601 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
4603 if ((!child
->IsFloating() || !wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode()) && child
->GetRange().GetLength() > 0 && !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(lineRange
) && !lineRange
.IsOutside(range
))
4605 // Draw this part of the line at the correct position
4606 wxRichTextRange
objectRange(child
->GetRange());
4607 objectRange
.LimitTo(lineRange
);
4610 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4612 objectSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4613 objectRange
= child
->GetOwnRange();
4617 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING && wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4618 if (i
< (int) line
->GetObjectSizes().GetCount())
4620 objectSize
.x
= line
->GetObjectSizes()[(size_t) i
];
4626 child
->GetRangeSize(objectRange
, objectSize
, descent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, objectPosition
);
4630 // Use the child object's width, but the whole line's height
4631 wxRect
childRect(objectPosition
, wxSize(objectSize
.x
, line
->GetSize().y
));
4632 child
->Draw(dc
, context
, objectRange
, selection
, childRect
, maxDescent
, style
);
4634 objectPosition
.x
+= objectSize
.x
;
4637 else if (child
->GetRange().GetStart() > lineRange
.GetEnd())
4638 // Can break out of inner loop now since we've passed this line's range
4641 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
4645 node
= node
->GetNext();
4651 // Get the range width using partial extents calculated for the whole paragraph.
4652 static int wxRichTextGetRangeWidth(const wxRichTextParagraph
& para
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxArrayInt
& partialExtents
)
4654 wxASSERT(partialExtents
.GetCount() >= (size_t) range
.GetLength());
4656 if (partialExtents
.GetCount() < (size_t) range
.GetLength())
4659 int leftMostPos
= 0;
4660 if (range
.GetStart() - para
.GetRange().GetStart() > 0)
4661 leftMostPos
= partialExtents
[range
.GetStart() - para
.GetRange().GetStart() - 1];
4663 int rightMostPos
= partialExtents
[range
.GetEnd() - para
.GetRange().GetStart()];
4665 int w
= rightMostPos
- leftMostPos
;
4670 /// Lay the item out
4671 bool wxRichTextParagraph::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxRect
& parentRect
, int style
)
4673 // Deal with floating objects firstly before the normal layout
4674 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4677 wxRichTextFloatCollector
* collector
= GetContainer()->GetFloatCollector();
4679 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
4681 wxASSERT(collector
!= NULL
);
4683 LayoutFloat(dc
, context
, rect
, parentRect
, style
, collector
);
4686 wxRichTextAttr attr
= GetCombinedAttributes();
4687 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, this);
4691 // Increase the size of the paragraph due to spacing
4692 int spaceBeforePara
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore());
4693 int spaceAfterPara
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter());
4694 int leftIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetLeftIndent());
4695 int leftSubIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetLeftSubIndent());
4696 int rightIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetRightIndent());
4698 int lineSpacing
= 0;
4700 // Let's assume line spacing of 10 is normal, 15 is 1.5, 20 is 2, etc.
4701 if (attr
.HasLineSpacing() && attr
.GetLineSpacing() > 0 && attr
.HasFont())
4703 wxFont
font(buffer
->GetFontTable().FindFont(attr
));
4706 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
4707 lineSpacing
= (int) (double(dc
.GetCharHeight()) * (double(attr
.GetLineSpacing())/10.0 - 1.0));
4711 // Start position for each line relative to the paragraph
4712 int startPositionFirstLine
= leftIndent
;
4713 int startPositionSubsequentLines
= leftIndent
+ leftSubIndent
;
4715 // If we have a bullet in this paragraph, the start position for the first line's text
4716 // is actually leftIndent + leftSubIndent.
4717 if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() != wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
)
4718 startPositionFirstLine
= startPositionSubsequentLines
;
4720 long lastEndPos
= GetRange().GetStart()-1;
4721 long lastCompletedEndPos
= lastEndPos
;
4723 int currentWidth
= 0;
4724 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
4726 wxPoint
currentPosition(0, spaceBeforePara
); // We will calculate lines relative to paragraph
4729 int maxHeight
= currentPosition
.y
;
4734 int lineDescent
= 0;
4736 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
;
4738 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4740 wxArrayInt partialExtents
;
4743 int paraDescent
= 0;
4745 // This calculates the partial text extents
4746 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
, rect
.GetPosition(), parentRect
.GetSize(), & partialExtents
);
4748 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4751 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4753 //child->SetCachedSize(wxDefaultSize);
4754 child
->Layout(dc
, context
, rect
, style
);
4756 node
= node
->GetNext();
4762 // We may need to go back to a previous child, in which case create the new line,
4763 // find the child corresponding to the start position of the string, and
4766 wxRect availableRect
;
4768 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4771 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4773 // If floating, ignore. We already laid out floats.
4774 // Also ignore if empty object, except if we haven't got any
4776 if ((child
->IsFloating() && wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
4777 || !child
->IsShown() || (child
->GetRange().GetLength() == 0 && maxHeight
> spaceBeforePara
)
4780 node
= node
->GetNext();
4784 // If this is e.g. a composite text box, it will need to be laid out itself.
4785 // But if just a text fragment or image, for example, this will
4786 // do nothing. NB: won't we need to set the position after layout?
4787 // since for example if position is dependent on vertical line size, we
4788 // can't tell the position until the size is determined. So possibly introduce
4789 // another layout phase.
4791 // We may only be looking at part of a child, if we searched back for wrapping
4792 // and found a suitable point some way into the child. So get the size for the fragment
4795 long nextBreakPos
= GetFirstLineBreakPosition(lastEndPos
+1);
4796 long lastPosToUse
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
4797 bool lineBreakInThisObject
= (nextBreakPos
> -1 && nextBreakPos
<= child
->GetRange().GetEnd());
4799 if (lineBreakInThisObject
)
4800 lastPosToUse
= nextBreakPos
;
4803 int childDescent
= 0;
4805 int startOffset
= (lineCount
== 0 ? startPositionFirstLine
: startPositionSubsequentLines
);
4806 availableRect
= wxRect(rect
.x
+ startOffset
, rect
.y
+ currentPosition
.y
,
4807 rect
.width
- startOffset
- rightIndent
, rect
.height
);
4809 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4811 wxSize oldSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4813 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
4814 child
->SetPosition(wxPoint(0, 0));
4816 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
4817 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
4818 // The position will be determined by its location in its line,
4819 // and not by the child's actual position.
4820 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, context
, buffer
,
4821 attr
, child
->GetAttributes(), availableRect
, parentRect
, style
);
4823 if (oldSize
!= child
->GetCachedSize())
4825 partialExtents
.Clear();
4827 // Recalculate the partial text extents since the child object changed size
4828 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
, wxPoint(0,0), parentRect
.GetSize(), & partialExtents
);
4832 // Problem: we need to layout composites here for which we need the available width,
4833 // but we can't get the available width without using the float collector which
4834 // needs to know the object height.
4836 if ((nextBreakPos
== -1) && (lastEndPos
== child
->GetRange().GetStart() - 1)) // i.e. we want to get the whole thing
4838 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4839 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
4843 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4844 // Get height only, then the width using the partial extents
4845 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(lastEndPos
+1, lastPosToUse
), childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
, wxPoint(0,0), parentRect
.GetSize());
4846 childSize
.x
= wxRichTextGetRangeWidth(*this, wxRichTextRange(lastEndPos
+1, lastPosToUse
), partialExtents
);
4848 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(lastEndPos
+1, lastPosToUse
), childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, rect
.GetPosition(), parentRect
.GetSize());
4853 int loopIterations
= 0;
4855 // If there are nested objects that need to lay themselves out, we have to do this in a
4856 // loop because the height of the object may well depend on the available width.
4857 // And because of floating object positioning, the available width depends on the
4858 // height of the object and whether it will clash with the floating objects.
4859 // So, we see whether the available width changes due to the presence of floating images.
4860 // If it does, then we'll use the new restricted width to find the object height again.
4861 // If this causes another restriction in the available width, we'll try again, until
4862 // either we lose patience or the available width settles down.
4867 wxRect oldAvailableRect
= availableRect
;
4869 // Available width depends on the floating objects and the line height.
4870 // Note: the floating objects may be placed vertically along the two sides of
4871 // buffer, so we may have different available line widths with different
4872 // [startY, endY]. So, we can't determine how wide the available
4873 // space is until we know the exact line height.
4874 if (childDescent
== 0)
4876 lineHeight
= wxMax(lineHeight
, childSize
.y
);
4877 lineDescent
= maxDescent
;
4878 lineAscent
= maxAscent
;
4882 lineDescent
= wxMax(childDescent
, maxDescent
);
4883 lineAscent
= wxMax(childSize
.y
-childDescent
, maxAscent
);
4885 lineHeight
= wxMax(lineHeight
, (lineDescent
+ lineAscent
));
4887 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && collector
)
4889 wxRect floatAvailableRect
= collector
->GetAvailableRect(rect
.y
+ currentPosition
.y
, rect
.y
+ currentPosition
.y
+ lineHeight
);
4891 // Adjust availableRect to the space that is available when taking floating objects into account.
4893 if (floatAvailableRect
.x
+ startOffset
> availableRect
.x
)
4895 int newX
= floatAvailableRect
.x
+ startOffset
;
4896 int newW
= availableRect
.width
- (newX
- availableRect
.x
);
4897 availableRect
.x
= newX
;
4898 availableRect
.width
= newW
;
4901 if (floatAvailableRect
.width
< availableRect
.width
)
4902 availableRect
.width
= floatAvailableRect
.width
;
4905 currentPosition
.x
= availableRect
.x
- rect
.x
;
4907 if (child
->IsTopLevel() && loopIterations
<= 20)
4909 if (availableRect
!= oldAvailableRect
)
4911 wxSize oldSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4913 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
4914 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
4915 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
4916 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, context
, buffer
,
4917 attr
, child
->GetAttributes(), availableRect
, parentRect
.GetSize(), style
);
4918 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4919 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
4921 if (oldSize
!= child
->GetCachedSize())
4923 partialExtents
.Clear();
4925 // Recalculate the partial text extents since the child object changed size
4926 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
, wxPoint(0,0), parentRect
.GetSize(), & partialExtents
);
4929 // Go around the loop finding the available rect for the given floating objects
4939 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4941 // We can move it to the correct position at this point
4942 // TODO: probably need to add margin
4943 child
->Move(GetPosition() + wxPoint(currentWidth
+ (wxMax(leftIndent
, leftIndent
+ leftSubIndent
)), currentPosition
.y
));
4947 // 1) There was a line break BEFORE the natural break
4948 // 2) There was a line break AFTER the natural break
4949 // 3) It's the last line
4950 // 4) The child still fits (carry on) - 'else' clause
4952 if ((lineBreakInThisObject
&& (childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
<= availableRect
.width
))
4954 (childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
> availableRect
.width
)
4957 ((childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
<= availableRect
.width
) && !node
->GetNext())
4961 long wrapPosition
= 0;
4962 if ((childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
<= availableRect
.width
) && !node
->GetNext() && !lineBreakInThisObject
)
4963 wrapPosition
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
4966 // Find a place to wrap. This may walk back to previous children,
4967 // for example if a word spans several objects.
4968 // Note: one object must contains only one wxTextAtrr, so the line height will not
4969 // change inside one object. Thus, we can pass the remain line width to the
4970 // FindWrapPosition function.
4971 if (!FindWrapPosition(wxRichTextRange(lastCompletedEndPos
+1, child
->GetRange().GetEnd()), dc
, context
, availableRect
.width
, wrapPosition
, & partialExtents
))
4973 // If the function failed, just cut it off at the end of this child.
4974 wrapPosition
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
4977 // FindWrapPosition can still return a value that will put us in an endless wrapping loop
4978 if (wrapPosition
<= lastCompletedEndPos
)
4979 wrapPosition
= wxMax(lastCompletedEndPos
+1,child
->GetRange().GetEnd());
4981 // Line end position shouldn't be the same as the end, or greater.
4982 if (wrapPosition
>= GetRange().GetEnd())
4983 wrapPosition
= wxMax(0, GetRange().GetEnd()-1);
4985 // wxLogDebug(wxT("Split at %ld"), wrapPosition);
4987 // Let's find the actual size of the current line now
4989 wxRichTextRange
actualRange(lastCompletedEndPos
+1, wrapPosition
);
4993 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4994 if (!child
->IsEmpty())
4996 // Get height only, then the width using the partial extents
4997 GetRangeSize(actualRange
, actualSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
, wxPoint(0,0), parentRect
.GetSize());
4998 actualSize
.x
= wxRichTextGetRangeWidth(*this, actualRange
, partialExtents
);
5002 GetRangeSize(actualRange
, actualSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, wxPoint(0,0), parentRect
.GetSize());
5004 currentWidth
= actualSize
.x
;
5006 // The descent for the whole line at this point, is the correct max descent
5007 maxDescent
= childDescent
;
5009 maxAscent
= actualSize
.y
-childDescent
;
5011 // lineHeight is given by the height for the whole line, since it will
5012 // take into account ascend/descend.
5013 lineHeight
= actualSize
.y
;
5015 if (lineHeight
== 0 && buffer
)
5017 wxFont
font(buffer
->GetFontTable().FindFont(attr
));
5018 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
5019 lineHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
5022 if (maxDescent
== 0)
5025 dc
.GetTextExtent(wxT("X"), & w
, &h
, & maxDescent
);
5029 wxRichTextLine
* line
= AllocateLine(lineCount
);
5031 // Set relative range so we won't have to change line ranges when paragraphs are moved
5032 line
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(actualRange
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart(), actualRange
.GetEnd() - GetRange().GetStart()));
5033 line
->SetPosition(currentPosition
);
5034 line
->SetSize(wxSize(currentWidth
, lineHeight
));
5035 line
->SetDescent(maxDescent
);
5037 maxHeight
= currentPosition
.y
+ lineHeight
;
5039 // Now move down a line. TODO: add margins, spacing
5040 currentPosition
.y
+= lineHeight
;
5041 currentPosition
.y
+= lineSpacing
;
5044 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, currentWidth
+startOffset
);
5049 // TODO: account for zero-length objects
5050 // wxASSERT(wrapPosition > lastCompletedEndPos);
5052 lastEndPos
= wrapPosition
;
5053 lastCompletedEndPos
= lastEndPos
;
5057 if (wrapPosition
< GetRange().GetEnd()-1)
5059 // May need to set the node back to a previous one, due to searching back in wrapping
5060 wxRichTextObject
* childAfterWrapPosition
= FindObjectAtPosition(wrapPosition
+1);
5061 if (childAfterWrapPosition
)
5062 node
= m_children
.Find(childAfterWrapPosition
);
5064 node
= node
->GetNext();
5067 node
= node
->GetNext();
5069 // Apply paragraph styles such as alignment to the wrapped line
5070 ApplyParagraphStyle(line
, attr
, availableRect
, dc
);
5074 // We still fit, so don't add a line, and keep going
5075 currentWidth
+= childSize
.x
;
5077 if (childDescent
== 0)
5079 // An object with a zero descend value wants to take up the whole
5080 // height regardless of baseline
5081 lineHeight
= wxMax(lineHeight
, childSize
.y
);
5085 maxDescent
= wxMax(childDescent
, maxDescent
);
5086 maxAscent
= wxMax(childSize
.y
-childDescent
, maxAscent
);
5089 lineHeight
= wxMax(lineHeight
, (maxDescent
+ maxAscent
));
5091 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, currentWidth
+startOffset
);
5092 lastEndPos
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
5094 node
= node
->GetNext();
5098 //wxASSERT(!(lastCompletedEndPos != -1 && lastCompletedEndPos < GetRange().GetEnd()-1));
5100 // Add the last line - it's the current pos -> last para pos
5101 // Substract -1 because the last position is always the end-paragraph position.
5102 if (lastCompletedEndPos
<= GetRange().GetEnd()-1)
5104 currentPosition
.x
= (lineCount
== 0 ? startPositionFirstLine
: startPositionSubsequentLines
);
5106 wxRichTextLine
* line
= AllocateLine(lineCount
);
5108 wxRichTextRange
actualRange(lastCompletedEndPos
+1, GetRange().GetEnd()-1);
5110 // Set relative range so we won't have to change line ranges when paragraphs are moved
5111 line
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(actualRange
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart(), actualRange
.GetEnd() - GetRange().GetStart()));
5113 line
->SetPosition(currentPosition
);
5115 if (lineHeight
== 0 && buffer
)
5117 wxFont
font(buffer
->GetFontTable().FindFont(attr
));
5118 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
5119 lineHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
5122 if (maxDescent
== 0)
5125 dc
.GetTextExtent(wxT("X"), & w
, &h
, & maxDescent
);
5128 line
->SetSize(wxSize(currentWidth
, lineHeight
));
5129 line
->SetDescent(maxDescent
);
5130 currentPosition
.y
+= lineHeight
;
5131 currentPosition
.y
+= lineSpacing
;
5134 // Apply paragraph styles such as alignment to the wrapped line
5135 ApplyParagraphStyle(line
, attr
, availableRect
, dc
);
5138 // Remove remaining unused line objects, if any
5139 ClearUnusedLines(lineCount
);
5141 // We need to add back the margins etc.
5143 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
5144 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxWidth
, currentPosition
.y
+ spaceAfterPara
));
5145 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
5146 SetCachedSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
5149 // The maximum size is the length of the paragraph stretched out into a line.
5150 // So if there were a single word, or an image, or a fixed-size text box, the object could be shrunk around
5151 // this size. TODO: take into account line breaks.
5153 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
5154 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(paraSize
.x
+ wxMax(leftIndent
, leftIndent
+ leftSubIndent
) + rightIndent
, currentPosition
.y
+ spaceAfterPara
));
5155 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
5156 SetMaxSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
5159 // Find the greatest minimum size. Currently we only look at non-text objects,
5160 // which isn't ideal but it would be slow to find the maximum word width to
5161 // use as the minimum.
5164 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5167 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5169 // If floating, ignore. We already laid out floats.
5170 // Also ignore if empty object, except if we haven't got any
5172 if ((!child
->IsFloating() || !wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode()) && child
->GetRange().GetLength() != 0 && !wxDynamicCast(child
, wxRichTextPlainText
))
5174 if (child
->GetCachedSize().x
> minWidth
)
5175 minWidth
= child
->GetMinSize().x
;
5177 node
= node
->GetNext();
5180 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
5181 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(minWidth
, currentPosition
.y
+ spaceAfterPara
));
5182 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
5183 SetMinSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
5186 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
5187 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING
5188 // Use the text extents to calculate the size of each fragment in each line
5189 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator lineNode
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
5192 wxRichTextLine
* line
= lineNode
->GetData();
5193 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
5195 // Loop through objects until we get to the one within range
5196 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5200 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
5202 if (child
->GetRange().GetLength() > 0 && !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(lineRange
))
5204 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= lineRange
;
5205 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
5207 // Find the size of the child from the text extents, and store in an array
5208 // for drawing later
5210 if (rangeToUse
.GetStart() > GetRange().GetStart())
5211 left
= partialExtents
[(rangeToUse
.GetStart()-1) - GetRange().GetStart()];
5212 int right
= partialExtents
[rangeToUse
.GetEnd() - GetRange().GetStart()];
5213 int sz
= right
- left
;
5214 line
->GetObjectSizes().Add(sz
);
5216 else if (child
->GetRange().GetStart() > lineRange
.GetEnd())
5217 // Can break out of inner loop now since we've passed this line's range
5220 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
5223 lineNode
= lineNode
->GetNext();
5231 /// Apply paragraph styles, such as centering, to wrapped lines
5232 /// TODO: take into account box attributes, possibly
5233 void wxRichTextParagraph::ApplyParagraphStyle(wxRichTextLine
* line
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
, wxDC
& dc
)
5235 if (!attr
.HasAlignment())
5238 wxPoint pos
= line
->GetPosition();
5239 wxPoint originalPos
= pos
;
5240 wxSize size
= line
->GetSize();
5242 // centering, right-justification
5243 if (attr
.HasAlignment() && attr
.GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_CENTRE
)
5245 int rightIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetRightIndent());
5246 pos
.x
= (rect
.GetWidth() - rightIndent
- size
.x
)/2 + pos
.x
;
5247 line
->SetPosition(pos
);
5249 else if (attr
.HasAlignment() && attr
.GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_RIGHT
)
5251 int rightIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetRightIndent());
5252 pos
.x
= pos
.x
+ rect
.GetWidth() - size
.x
- rightIndent
;
5253 line
->SetPosition(pos
);
5256 if (pos
!= originalPos
)
5258 wxPoint inc
= pos
- originalPos
;
5260 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5264 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5265 if (child
->IsTopLevel() && !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(line
->GetAbsoluteRange()))
5266 child
->Move(child
->GetPosition() + inc
);
5268 node
= node
->GetNext();
5273 /// Insert text at the given position
5274 bool wxRichTextParagraph::InsertText(long pos
, const wxString
& text
)
5276 wxRichTextObject
* childToUse
= NULL
;
5277 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator nodeToUse
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
5279 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5282 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5283 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
) && child
->GetRange().GetLength() > 0)
5290 node
= node
->GetNext();
5295 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObject
= wxDynamicCast(childToUse
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
5298 int posInString
= pos
- textObject
->GetRange().GetStart();
5300 wxString newText
= textObject
->GetText().Mid(0, posInString
) +
5301 text
+ textObject
->GetText().Mid(posInString
);
5302 textObject
->SetText(newText
);
5304 int textLength
= text
.length();
5306 textObject
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(textObject
->GetRange().GetStart(),
5307 textObject
->GetRange().GetEnd() + textLength
));
5309 // Increment the end range of subsequent fragments in this paragraph.
5310 // We'll set the paragraph range itself at a higher level.
5312 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= nodeToUse
->GetNext();
5315 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5316 child
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(textObject
->GetRange().GetStart() + textLength
,
5317 textObject
->GetRange().GetEnd() + textLength
));
5319 node
= node
->GetNext();
5326 // TODO: if not a text object, insert at closest position, e.g. in front of it
5332 // Don't pass parent initially to suppress auto-setting of parent range.
5333 // We'll do that at a higher level.
5334 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObject
= new wxRichTextPlainText(text
, this);
5336 AppendChild(textObject
);
5343 void wxRichTextParagraph::Copy(const wxRichTextParagraph
& obj
)
5345 wxRichTextCompositeObject::Copy(obj
);
5348 /// Clear the cached lines
5349 void wxRichTextParagraph::ClearLines()
5351 WX_CLEAR_LIST(wxRichTextLineList
, m_cachedLines
);
5354 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
5355 /// is invalid for this object.
5356 bool wxRichTextParagraph::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int flags
, const wxPoint
& position
, const wxSize
& parentSize
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
5358 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
5361 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
)
5363 // Just use unformatted data, assume no line breaks
5366 wxArrayInt childExtents
;
5375 int maxLineHeight
= 0;
5377 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5380 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5381 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
5383 // Floating objects have a zero size within the paragraph.
5384 if (child
->IsFloating() && wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode())
5389 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
5390 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
5394 partialExtents
->Add(0 /* zero size */ + lastSize
);
5401 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= range
;
5402 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
5403 int childDescent
= 0;
5405 // At present wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY is only fast if we've already cached the size,
5406 // but it's only going to be used after caching has taken place.
5407 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
) && child
->GetCachedSize().y
!= 0)
5409 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
5410 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
5412 if (childDescent
== 0)
5414 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, childSize
.y
);
5418 maxDescent
= wxMax(maxDescent
, childDescent
);
5419 maxAscent
= wxMax(maxAscent
, (childSize
.y
- childDescent
));
5422 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, (maxAscent
+ maxDescent
));
5424 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, maxLineHeight
);
5425 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
5426 descent
= maxDescent
;
5428 else if (child
->IsTopLevel())
5430 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
5431 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
5433 if (childDescent
== 0)
5435 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, childSize
.y
);
5439 maxDescent
= wxMax(maxDescent
, childDescent
);
5440 maxAscent
= wxMax(maxAscent
, (childSize
.y
- childDescent
));
5443 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, (maxAscent
+ maxDescent
));
5445 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, maxLineHeight
);
5446 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
5447 descent
= maxDescent
;
5449 // FIXME: this won't change the original values.
5450 // Should we be calling GetRangeSize above instead of using cached values?
5452 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
) && (rangeToUse
== child
->GetRange()))
5454 child
->SetCachedSize(childSize
);
5455 child
->SetDescent(childDescent
);
5462 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
5463 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
5467 partialExtents
->Add(childSize
.x
+ lastSize
);
5470 else if (child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, flags
, wxPoint(position
.x
+ sz
.x
, position
.y
), parentSize
, p
))
5472 if (childDescent
== 0)
5474 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, childSize
.y
);
5478 maxDescent
= wxMax(maxDescent
, childDescent
);
5479 maxAscent
= wxMax(maxAscent
, (childSize
.y
- childDescent
));
5482 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, (maxAscent
+ maxDescent
));
5484 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, maxLineHeight
);
5485 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
5486 descent
= maxDescent
;
5488 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
) && (rangeToUse
== child
->GetRange()))
5490 child
->SetCachedSize(childSize
);
5491 child
->SetDescent(childDescent
);
5497 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
5498 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
5503 for (i
= 0; i
< childExtents
.GetCount(); i
++)
5505 partialExtents
->Add(childExtents
[i
] + lastSize
);
5515 node
= node
->GetNext();
5521 // Use formatted data, with line breaks
5524 // We're going to loop through each line, and then for each line,
5525 // call GetRangeSize for the fragment that comprises that line.
5526 // Only we have to do that multiple times within the line, because
5527 // the line may be broken into pieces. For now ignore line break commands
5528 // (so we can assume that getting the unformatted size for a fragment
5529 // within a line is the actual size)
5531 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
5534 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
5535 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
5536 if (!lineRange
.IsOutside(range
))
5540 int maxLineHeight
= 0;
5541 int maxLineWidth
= 0;
5543 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5546 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
5548 if ((!child
->IsFloating() || !wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode()) && !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(lineRange
))
5550 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= lineRange
;
5551 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
5552 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
5553 rangeToUse
= child
->GetOwnRange();
5556 int childDescent
= 0;
5557 if (child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, context
, flags
, wxPoint(position
.x
+ sz
.x
, position
.y
), parentSize
))
5559 if (childDescent
== 0)
5561 // Assume that if descent is zero, this child can occupy the full line height
5562 // and does not need space for the line's maximum descent. So we influence
5563 // the overall max line height only.
5564 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, childSize
.y
);
5568 maxAscent
= wxMax(maxAscent
, (childSize
.y
- childDescent
));
5569 maxDescent
= wxMax(maxAscent
, childDescent
);
5571 maxLineHeight
= wxMax(maxLineHeight
, (maxAscent
+ maxDescent
));
5572 maxLineWidth
+= childSize
.x
;
5576 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
5579 descent
= wxMax(descent
, maxDescent
);
5581 // Increase size by a line (TODO: paragraph spacing)
5582 sz
.y
+= maxLineHeight
;
5583 sz
.x
= wxMax(sz
.x
, maxLineWidth
);
5585 node
= node
->GetNext();
5592 /// Finds the absolute position and row height for the given character position
5593 bool wxRichTextParagraph::FindPosition(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, long index
, wxPoint
& pt
, int* height
, bool forceLineStart
)
5597 wxRichTextLine
* line
= ((wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
*)GetParent())->GetLineAtPosition(0);
5599 *height
= line
->GetSize().y
;
5601 *height
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
5603 // -1 means 'the start of the buffer'.
5606 pt
= pt
+ line
->GetPosition();
5611 // The final position in a paragraph is taken to mean the position
5612 // at the start of the next paragraph.
5613 if (index
== GetRange().GetEnd())
5615 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* parent
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
5616 wxASSERT( parent
!= NULL
);
5618 // Find the height at the next paragraph, if any
5619 wxRichTextLine
* line
= parent
->GetLineAtPosition(index
+ 1);
5622 *height
= line
->GetSize().y
;
5623 pt
= line
->GetAbsolutePosition();
5627 *height
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
5628 int indent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, m_attributes
.GetLeftIndent());
5629 pt
= wxPoint(indent
, GetCachedSize().y
);
5635 if (index
< GetRange().GetStart() || index
> GetRange().GetEnd())
5638 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
5641 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
5642 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
5643 if (index
>= lineRange
.GetStart() && index
<= lineRange
.GetEnd())
5645 // If this is the last point in the line, and we're forcing the
5646 // returned value to be the start of the next line, do the required
5648 if (index
== lineRange
.GetEnd() && forceLineStart
)
5650 if (node
->GetNext())
5652 wxRichTextLine
* nextLine
= node
->GetNext()->GetData();
5653 *height
= nextLine
->GetSize().y
;
5654 pt
= nextLine
->GetAbsolutePosition();
5659 pt
.y
= line
->GetPosition().y
+ GetPosition().y
;
5661 wxRichTextRange
r(lineRange
.GetStart(), index
);
5665 // We find the size of the line up to this point,
5666 // then we can add this size to the line start position and
5667 // paragraph start position to find the actual position.
5669 if (GetRangeSize(r
, rangeSize
, descent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, line
->GetPosition()+ GetPosition()))
5671 pt
.x
= line
->GetPosition().x
+ GetPosition().x
+ rangeSize
.x
;
5672 *height
= line
->GetSize().y
;
5679 node
= node
->GetNext();
5685 /// Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
5686 /// information about position
5687 int wxRichTextParagraph::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
5690 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
5692 // If we're in the top-level container, then we can return
5693 // a suitable hit test code even if the point is outside the container area,
5694 // so that we can position the caret sensibly even if we don't
5695 // click on valid content. If we're not at the top-level, and the point
5696 // is not within this paragraph object, then we don't want to stop more
5697 // precise hit-testing from working prematurely, so return immediately.
5698 // NEW STRATEGY: use the parent boundary to test whether we're in the
5699 // right region, not the paragraph, since the paragraph may be positioned
5700 // some way in from where the user clicks.
5703 wxRichTextObject
* tempObj
, *tempContextObj
;
5704 if (GetParent() && GetParent()->wxRichTextObject::HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, tmpPos
, & tempObj
, & tempContextObj
, flags
) == wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
5705 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
5708 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator objNode
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5711 wxRichTextObject
* child
= objNode
->GetData();
5712 // Don't recurse if we have wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NO_NESTED_OBJECTS,
5713 // and also, if this seems composite but actually is marked as atomic,
5715 if (child
->IsTopLevel() && ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NO_NESTED_OBJECTS
) == 0) &&
5716 (! (((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_HONOUR_ATOMIC
) != 0) && child
->IsAtomic())))
5719 int hitTest
= child
->HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
);
5720 if (hitTest
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
5725 objNode
= objNode
->GetNext();
5728 wxPoint paraPos
= GetPosition();
5730 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
5733 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
5734 wxPoint linePos
= paraPos
+ line
->GetPosition();
5735 wxSize lineSize
= line
->GetSize();
5736 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
5738 if (pt
.y
<= linePos
.y
+ lineSize
.y
)
5740 if (pt
.x
< linePos
.x
)
5742 textPosition
= lineRange
.GetStart();
5743 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5744 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5745 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
|wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_OUTSIDE
;
5747 else if (pt
.x
>= (linePos
.x
+ lineSize
.x
))
5749 textPosition
= lineRange
.GetEnd();
5750 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5751 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5752 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
|wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_OUTSIDE
;
5756 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
5757 wxArrayInt partialExtents
;
5762 // This calculates the partial text extents
5763 GetRangeSize(lineRange
, paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, linePos
, wxDefaultSize
, & partialExtents
);
5765 int lastX
= linePos
.x
;
5767 for (i
= 0; i
< partialExtents
.GetCount(); i
++)
5769 int nextX
= partialExtents
[i
] + linePos
.x
;
5771 if (pt
.x
>= lastX
&& pt
.x
<= nextX
)
5773 textPosition
= i
+ lineRange
.GetStart(); // minus 1?
5775 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5776 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5778 // So now we know it's between i-1 and i.
5779 // Let's see if we can be more precise about
5780 // which side of the position it's on.
5782 int midPoint
= (nextX
+ lastX
)/2;
5783 if (pt
.x
>= midPoint
)
5784 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
;
5786 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
;
5793 int lastX
= linePos
.x
;
5794 for (i
= lineRange
.GetStart(); i
<= lineRange
.GetEnd(); i
++)
5799 wxRichTextRange
rangeToUse(lineRange
.GetStart(), i
);
5801 GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, descent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, linePos
);
5803 int nextX
= childSize
.x
+ linePos
.x
;
5805 if (pt
.x
>= lastX
&& pt
.x
<= nextX
)
5809 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5810 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5812 // So now we know it's between i-1 and i.
5813 // Let's see if we can be more precise about
5814 // which side of the position it's on.
5816 int midPoint
= (nextX
+ lastX
)/2;
5817 if (pt
.x
>= midPoint
)
5818 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
;
5820 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
;
5831 node
= node
->GetNext();
5834 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
5837 /// Split an object at this position if necessary, and return
5838 /// the previous object, or NULL if inserting at beginning.
5839 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraph::SplitAt(long pos
, wxRichTextObject
** previousObject
)
5841 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5844 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5846 if (pos
== child
->GetRange().GetStart())
5850 if (node
->GetPrevious())
5851 *previousObject
= node
->GetPrevious()->GetData();
5853 *previousObject
= NULL
;
5859 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
5861 // This should create a new object, transferring part of
5862 // the content to the old object and the rest to the new object.
5863 wxRichTextObject
* newObject
= child
->DoSplit(pos
);
5865 // If we couldn't split this object, just insert in front of it.
5868 // Maybe this is an empty string, try the next one
5873 // Insert the new object after 'child'
5874 if (node
->GetNext())
5875 m_children
.Insert(node
->GetNext(), newObject
);
5877 m_children
.Append(newObject
);
5878 newObject
->SetParent(this);
5881 *previousObject
= child
;
5887 node
= node
->GetNext();
5890 *previousObject
= NULL
;
5894 /// Move content to a list from obj on
5895 void wxRichTextParagraph::MoveToList(wxRichTextObject
* obj
, wxList
& list
)
5897 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(obj
);
5900 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5903 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator oldNode
= node
;
5905 node
= node
->GetNext();
5907 m_children
.DeleteNode(oldNode
);
5911 /// Add content back from list
5912 void wxRichTextParagraph::MoveFromList(wxList
& list
)
5914 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= list
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
5916 AppendChild((wxRichTextObject
*) node
->GetData());
5921 void wxRichTextParagraph::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
5923 wxRichTextCompositeObject::CalculateRange(start
, end
);
5925 // Add one for end of paragraph
5928 m_range
.SetRange(start
, end
);
5931 /// Find the object at the given position
5932 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraph::FindObjectAtPosition(long position
)
5934 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5937 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
5938 if (obj
->GetRange().Contains(position
) ||
5939 obj
->GetRange().GetStart() == position
||
5940 obj
->GetRange().GetEnd() == position
)
5943 node
= node
->GetNext();
5948 /// Get the plain text searching from the start or end of the range.
5949 /// The resulting string may be shorter than the range given.
5950 bool wxRichTextParagraph::GetContiguousPlainText(wxString
& text
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, bool fromStart
)
5952 text
= wxEmptyString
;
5956 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5959 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
5960 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
5962 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObj
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
5965 text
+= textObj
->GetTextForRange(range
);
5973 node
= node
->GetNext();
5978 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetLast();
5981 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
5982 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
5984 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObj
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
5987 text
= textObj
->GetTextForRange(range
) + text
;
5991 text
= wxT(" ") + text
;
5995 node
= node
->GetPrevious();
6002 /// Find a suitable wrap position.
6003 bool wxRichTextParagraph::FindWrapPosition(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int availableSpace
, long& wrapPosition
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
)
6005 if (range
.GetLength() <= 0)
6008 // Find the first position where the line exceeds the available space.
6010 long breakPosition
= range
.GetEnd();
6012 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
6013 if (partialExtents
&& partialExtents
->GetCount() >= (size_t) (GetRange().GetLength()-1)) // the final position in a paragraph is the newline
6017 if (range
.GetStart() > GetRange().GetStart())
6018 widthBefore
= (*partialExtents
)[range
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart() - 1];
6023 for (i
= (size_t) range
.GetStart(); i
<= (size_t) range
.GetEnd(); i
++)
6025 int widthFromStartOfThisRange
= (*partialExtents
)[i
- GetRange().GetStart()] - widthBefore
;
6027 if (widthFromStartOfThisRange
> availableSpace
)
6029 breakPosition
= i
-1;
6037 // Binary chop for speed
6038 long minPos
= range
.GetStart();
6039 long maxPos
= range
.GetEnd();
6042 if (minPos
== maxPos
)
6045 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), minPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
6047 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
6048 breakPosition
= minPos
- 1;
6051 else if ((maxPos
- minPos
) == 1)
6054 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), minPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
6056 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
6057 breakPosition
= minPos
- 1;
6060 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), maxPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
6061 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
6062 breakPosition
= maxPos
-1;
6068 long nextPos
= minPos
+ ((maxPos
- minPos
) / 2);
6071 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), nextPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, context
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
6073 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
6085 // Now we know the last position on the line.
6086 // Let's try to find a word break.
6089 if (GetContiguousPlainText(plainText
, wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), breakPosition
), false))
6091 int newLinePos
= plainText
.Find(wxRichTextLineBreakChar
);
6092 if (newLinePos
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
6094 breakPosition
= wxMax(0, range
.GetStart() + newLinePos
);
6098 int spacePos
= plainText
.Find(wxT(' '), true);
6099 int tabPos
= plainText
.Find(wxT('\t'), true);
6100 int pos
= wxMax(spacePos
, tabPos
);
6101 if (pos
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
6103 int positionsFromEndOfString
= plainText
.length() - pos
- 1;
6104 breakPosition
= breakPosition
- positionsFromEndOfString
;
6109 wrapPosition
= breakPosition
;
6114 /// Get the bullet text for this paragraph.
6115 wxString
wxRichTextParagraph::GetBulletText()
6117 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() == wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
||
6118 (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_BITMAP
))
6119 return wxEmptyString
;
6121 int number
= GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber();
6124 if ((GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ARABIC
) || (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
))
6126 text
.Printf(wxT("%d"), number
);
6128 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_LETTERS_UPPER
)
6130 // TODO: Unicode, and also check if number > 26
6131 text
.Printf(wxT("%c"), (wxChar
) (number
+64));
6133 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_LETTERS_LOWER
)
6135 // TODO: Unicode, and also check if number > 26
6136 text
.Printf(wxT("%c"), (wxChar
) (number
+96));
6138 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ROMAN_UPPER
)
6140 text
= wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(number
);
6142 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ROMAN_LOWER
)
6144 text
= wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(number
);
6147 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_SYMBOL
)
6149 text
= GetAttributes().GetBulletText();
6152 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
)
6154 // The outline style relies on the text being computed statically,
6155 // since it depends on other levels points (e.g. 1.2.1.1). So normally the bullet text
6156 // should be stored in the attributes; if not, just use the number for this
6157 // level, as previously computed.
6158 if (!GetAttributes().GetBulletText().IsEmpty())
6159 text
= GetAttributes().GetBulletText();
6162 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_PARENTHESES
)
6164 text
= wxT("(") + text
+ wxT(")");
6166 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS
)
6168 text
= text
+ wxT(")");
6171 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_PERIOD
)
6179 /// Allocate or reuse a line object
6180 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraph::AllocateLine(int pos
)
6182 if (pos
< (int) m_cachedLines
.GetCount())
6184 wxRichTextLine
* line
= m_cachedLines
.Item(pos
)->GetData();
6190 wxRichTextLine
* line
= new wxRichTextLine(this);
6191 m_cachedLines
.Append(line
);
6196 /// Clear remaining unused line objects, if any
6197 bool wxRichTextParagraph::ClearUnusedLines(int lineCount
)
6199 int cachedLineCount
= m_cachedLines
.GetCount();
6200 if ((int) cachedLineCount
> lineCount
)
6202 for (int i
= 0; i
< (int) (cachedLineCount
- lineCount
); i
++)
6204 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetLast();
6205 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
6206 m_cachedLines
.Erase(node
);
6213 /// Get combined attributes of the base style, paragraph style and character style. We use this to dynamically
6214 /// retrieve the actual style.
6215 wxRichTextAttr
wxRichTextParagraph::GetCombinedAttributes(const wxRichTextAttr
& contentStyle
, bool includingBoxAttr
) const
6217 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
6218 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* buf
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
6221 attr
= buf
->GetBasicStyle();
6222 if (!includingBoxAttr
)
6224 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
6225 // The background colour will be painted by the container, and we don't
6226 // want to unnecessarily overwrite the background when we're drawing text
6227 // because this may erase the guideline (which appears just under the text
6228 // if there's no padding).
6229 attr
.SetFlags(attr
.GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
6231 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, GetAttributes());
6234 attr
= GetAttributes();
6236 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, contentStyle
);
6240 /// Get combined attributes of the base style and paragraph style.
6241 wxRichTextAttr
wxRichTextParagraph::GetCombinedAttributes(bool includingBoxAttr
) const
6243 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
6244 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* buf
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
6247 attr
= buf
->GetBasicStyle();
6248 if (!includingBoxAttr
)
6249 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
6250 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, GetAttributes());
6253 attr
= GetAttributes();
6258 // Create default tabstop array
6259 void wxRichTextParagraph::InitDefaultTabs()
6261 // create a default tab list at 10 mm each.
6262 for (int i
= 0; i
< 20; ++i
)
6264 sm_defaultTabs
.Add(i
*100);
6268 // Clear default tabstop array
6269 void wxRichTextParagraph::ClearDefaultTabs()
6271 sm_defaultTabs
.Clear();
6274 void wxRichTextParagraph::LayoutFloat(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxRect
& parentRect
, int style
, wxRichTextFloatCollector
* floatCollector
)
6276 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= GetChildren().GetFirst();
6279 wxRichTextObject
* anchored
= node
->GetData();
6280 if (anchored
&& anchored
->IsFloating() && !floatCollector
->HasFloat(anchored
))
6283 wxRichTextAttr
parentAttr(GetAttributes());
6284 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(parentAttr
, this);
6287 wxRect availableSpace
= GetParent()->GetAvailableContentArea(dc
, context
, rect
);
6289 anchored
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, context
, GetBuffer(),
6290 parentAttr
, anchored
->GetAttributes(),
6291 parentRect
, availableSpace
,
6293 wxSize size
= anchored
->GetCachedSize();
6297 anchored
->GetRangeSize(anchored
->GetRange(), size
, descent
, dc
, context
, style
);
6301 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().IsValid())
6303 offsetY
= anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().GetValue();
6304 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
6306 offsetY
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, offsetY
);
6310 int pos
= floatCollector
->GetFitPosition(anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetFloatMode(), rect
.y
+ offsetY
, size
.y
);
6312 /* Update the offset */
6313 int newOffsetY
= pos
- rect
.y
;
6314 if (newOffsetY
!= offsetY
)
6316 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
6317 newOffsetY
= ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(dc
, newOffsetY
);
6318 anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().SetValue(newOffsetY
);
6321 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetFloatMode() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_LEFT
)
6323 else if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetFloatMode() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_RIGHT
)
6324 x
= rect
.x
+ rect
.width
- size
.x
;
6326 //anchored->SetPosition(wxPoint(x, pos));
6327 anchored
->Move(wxPoint(x
, pos
)); // should move children
6328 anchored
->SetCachedSize(size
);
6329 floatCollector
->CollectFloat(this, anchored
);
6332 node
= node
->GetNext();
6336 // Get the first position from pos that has a line break character.
6337 long wxRichTextParagraph::GetFirstLineBreakPosition(long pos
)
6339 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
6342 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
6343 if (pos
>= obj
->GetRange().GetStart() && pos
<= obj
->GetRange().GetEnd())
6345 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObj
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
6348 long breakPos
= textObj
->GetFirstLineBreakPosition(pos
);
6353 node
= node
->GetNext();
6360 * This object represents a line in a paragraph, and stores
6361 * offsets from the start of the paragraph representing the
6362 * start and end positions of the line.
6365 wxRichTextLine::wxRichTextLine(wxRichTextParagraph
* parent
)
6371 void wxRichTextLine::Init(wxRichTextParagraph
* parent
)
6374 m_range
.SetRange(-1, -1);
6375 m_pos
= wxPoint(0, 0);
6376 m_size
= wxSize(0, 0);
6378 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING
6379 m_objectSizes
.Clear();
6384 void wxRichTextLine::Copy(const wxRichTextLine
& obj
)
6386 m_range
= obj
.m_range
;
6387 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING
6388 m_objectSizes
= obj
.m_objectSizes
;
6392 /// Get the absolute object position
6393 wxPoint
wxRichTextLine::GetAbsolutePosition() const
6395 return m_parent
->GetPosition() + m_pos
;
6398 /// Get the absolute range
6399 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextLine::GetAbsoluteRange() const
6401 wxRichTextRange
range(m_range
.GetStart() + m_parent
->GetRange().GetStart(), 0);
6402 range
.SetEnd(range
.GetStart() + m_range
.GetLength()-1);
6407 * wxRichTextPlainText
6408 * This object represents a single piece of text.
6411 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextPlainText
, wxRichTextObject
)
6413 wxRichTextPlainText::wxRichTextPlainText(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* style
):
6414 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
6417 SetAttributes(*style
);
6422 #define USE_KERNING_FIX 1
6424 // If insufficient tabs are defined, this is the tab width used
6425 #define WIDTH_FOR_DEFAULT_TABS 50
6428 bool wxRichTextPlainText::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int WXUNUSED(style
))
6430 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
6431 wxASSERT (para
!= NULL
);
6433 wxRichTextAttr
textAttr(para
? para
->GetCombinedAttributes(GetAttributes(), false /* no box attributes */) : GetAttributes());
6434 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(textAttr
, this);
6436 // Let's make the assumption for now that for content in a paragraph, including
6437 // text, we never have a discontinuous selection. So we only deal with a
6439 wxRichTextRange selectionRange
;
6440 if (selection
.IsValid())
6442 wxRichTextRangeArray selectionRanges
= selection
.GetSelectionForObject(this);
6443 if (selectionRanges
.GetCount() > 0)
6444 selectionRange
= selectionRanges
[0];
6446 selectionRange
= wxRICHTEXT_NO_SELECTION
;
6449 selectionRange
= wxRICHTEXT_NO_SELECTION
;
6451 int offset
= GetRange().GetStart();
6453 wxString str
= m_text
;
6454 if (context
.HasVirtualText(this))
6456 if (!context
.GetVirtualText(this, str
) || str
.Length() != m_text
.Length())
6460 // Replace line break characters with spaces
6461 wxString toRemove
= wxRichTextLineBreakChar
;
6462 str
.Replace(toRemove
, wxT(" "));
6463 if (textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & (wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_CAPITALS
|wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SMALL_CAPITALS
)))
6466 long len
= range
.GetLength();
6467 wxString stringChunk
= str
.Mid(range
.GetStart() - offset
, (size_t) len
);
6469 // Test for the optimized situations where all is selected, or none
6472 wxFont
textFont(GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(textAttr
));
6473 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
6474 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
6477 if ( textFont
.IsOk() )
6479 if (textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SMALL_CAPITALS
))
6481 textFont
.SetPointSize((int) (textFont
.GetPointSize()*0.75));
6482 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
6483 charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
6486 if ( textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUPERSCRIPT
) )
6488 if (textFont
.IsUsingSizeInPixels())
6490 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPixelSize().y
) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
6491 textFont
.SetPixelSize(wxSize(0, static_cast<int>(size
)));
6497 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPointSize()) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
6498 textFont
.SetPointSize(static_cast<int>(size
));
6502 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
6504 else if ( textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUBSCRIPT
) )
6506 if (textFont
.IsUsingSizeInPixels())
6508 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPixelSize().y
) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
6509 textFont
.SetPixelSize(wxSize(0, static_cast<int>(size
)));
6511 int sub_height
= static_cast<int>(static_cast<double>(charHeight
) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
);
6512 y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- sub_height
+ (descent
- m_descent
));
6516 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPointSize()) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
6517 textFont
.SetPointSize(static_cast<int>(size
));
6519 int sub_height
= static_cast<int>(static_cast<double>(charHeight
) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
);
6520 y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- sub_height
+ (descent
- m_descent
));
6522 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
6527 y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
- (descent
- m_descent
));
6533 y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
- (descent
- m_descent
));
6536 // TODO: new selection code
6538 // (a) All selected.
6539 if (selectionRange
.GetStart() <= range
.GetStart() && selectionRange
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetEnd())
6541 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringChunk
, x
, y
, true);
6543 // (b) None selected.
6544 else if (selectionRange
.GetEnd() < range
.GetStart() || selectionRange
.GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
6546 // Draw all unselected
6547 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringChunk
, x
, y
, false);
6551 // (c) Part selected, part not
6552 // Let's draw unselected chunk, selected chunk, then unselected chunk.
6554 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
6556 // 1. Initial unselected chunk, if any, up until start of selection.
6557 if (selectionRange
.GetStart() > range
.GetStart() && selectionRange
.GetStart() <= range
.GetEnd())
6559 int r1
= range
.GetStart();
6560 int s1
= selectionRange
.GetStart()-1;
6561 int fragmentLen
= s1
- r1
+ 1;
6562 if (fragmentLen
< 0)
6564 wxLogDebug(wxT("Mid(%d, %d"), (int)(r1
- offset
), (int)fragmentLen
);
6566 wxString stringFragment
= str
.Mid(r1
- offset
, fragmentLen
);
6568 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringFragment
, x
, y
, false);
6571 if (stringChunk
.Find(wxT("\t")) == wxNOT_FOUND
)
6573 // Compensate for kerning difference
6574 wxString
stringFragment2(str
.Mid(r1
- offset
, fragmentLen
+1));
6575 wxString
stringFragment3(str
.Mid(r1
- offset
+ fragmentLen
, 1));
6577 wxCoord w1
, h1
, w2
, h2
, w3
, h3
;
6578 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment
, & w1
, & h1
);
6579 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment2
, & w2
, & h2
);
6580 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment3
, & w3
, & h3
);
6582 int kerningDiff
= (w1
+ w3
) - w2
;
6583 x
= x
- kerningDiff
;
6588 // 2. Selected chunk, if any.
6589 if (selectionRange
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetStart())
6591 int s1
= wxMax(selectionRange
.GetStart(), range
.GetStart());
6592 int s2
= wxMin(selectionRange
.GetEnd(), range
.GetEnd());
6594 int fragmentLen
= s2
- s1
+ 1;
6595 if (fragmentLen
< 0)
6597 wxLogDebug(wxT("Mid(%d, %d"), (int)(s1
- offset
), (int)fragmentLen
);
6599 wxString stringFragment
= str
.Mid(s1
- offset
, fragmentLen
);
6601 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringFragment
, x
, y
, true);
6604 if (stringChunk
.Find(wxT("\t")) == wxNOT_FOUND
)
6606 // Compensate for kerning difference
6607 wxString
stringFragment2(str
.Mid(s1
- offset
, fragmentLen
+1));
6608 wxString
stringFragment3(str
.Mid(s1
- offset
+ fragmentLen
, 1));
6610 wxCoord w1
, h1
, w2
, h2
, w3
, h3
;
6611 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment
, & w1
, & h1
);
6612 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment2
, & w2
, & h2
);
6613 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment3
, & w3
, & h3
);
6615 int kerningDiff
= (w1
+ w3
) - w2
;
6616 x
= x
- kerningDiff
;
6621 // 3. Remaining unselected chunk, if any
6622 if (selectionRange
.GetEnd() < range
.GetEnd())
6624 int s2
= wxMin(selectionRange
.GetEnd()+1, range
.GetEnd());
6625 int r2
= range
.GetEnd();
6627 int fragmentLen
= r2
- s2
+ 1;
6628 if (fragmentLen
< 0)
6630 wxLogDebug(wxT("Mid(%d, %d"), (int)(s2
- offset
), (int)fragmentLen
);
6632 wxString stringFragment
= str
.Mid(s2
- offset
, fragmentLen
);
6634 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringFragment
, x
, y
, false);
6641 bool wxRichTextPlainText::DrawTabbedString(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
,wxString
& str
, wxCoord
& x
, wxCoord
& y
, bool selected
)
6643 bool hasTabs
= (str
.Find(wxT('\t')) != wxNOT_FOUND
);
6645 wxArrayInt tabArray
;
6649 if (attr
.GetTabs().IsEmpty())
6650 tabArray
= wxRichTextParagraph::GetDefaultTabs();
6652 tabArray
= attr
.GetTabs();
6653 tabCount
= tabArray
.GetCount();
6655 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
; ++i
)
6657 int pos
= tabArray
[i
];
6658 pos
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, pos
);
6665 int nextTabPos
= -1;
6671 wxColour
highlightColour(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT
));
6672 wxColour
highlightTextColour(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT
));
6674 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, wxBrush(highlightColour
));
6675 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(highlightColour
));
6676 dc
.SetTextForeground(highlightTextColour
);
6677 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
6681 dc
.SetTextForeground(attr
.GetTextColour());
6683 if (attr
.HasFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
) && attr
.GetBackgroundColour().IsOk())
6685 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID
);
6686 dc
.SetTextBackground(attr
.GetBackgroundColour());
6689 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
6692 wxCoord x_orig
= GetParent()->GetPosition().x
;
6695 // the string has a tab
6696 // break up the string at the Tab
6697 wxString stringChunk
= str
.BeforeFirst(wxT('\t'));
6698 str
= str
.AfterFirst(wxT('\t'));
6699 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringChunk
, & w
, & h
);
6701 bool not_found
= true;
6702 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
&& not_found
; ++i
)
6704 nextTabPos
= tabArray
.Item(i
) + x_orig
;
6706 // Find the next tab position.
6707 // Even if we're at the end of the tab array, we must still draw the chunk.
6709 if (nextTabPos
> tabPos
|| (i
== (tabCount
- 1)))
6711 if (nextTabPos
<= tabPos
)
6713 int defaultTabWidth
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, WIDTH_FOR_DEFAULT_TABS
);
6714 nextTabPos
= tabPos
+ defaultTabWidth
;
6721 wxRect
selRect(x
, rect
.y
, w
, rect
.GetHeight());
6722 dc
.DrawRectangle(selRect
);
6724 dc
.DrawText(stringChunk
, x
, y
);
6726 if (attr
.HasTextEffects() && (attr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_STRIKETHROUGH
))
6728 wxPen oldPen
= dc
.GetPen();
6729 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(attr
.GetTextColour(), 1));
6730 dc
.DrawLine(x
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5), x
+w
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5));
6731 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, oldPen
);
6737 hasTabs
= (str
.Find(wxT('\t')) != wxNOT_FOUND
);
6742 dc
.GetTextExtent(str
, & w
, & h
);
6745 wxRect
selRect(x
, rect
.y
, w
, rect
.GetHeight());
6746 dc
.DrawRectangle(selRect
);
6748 dc
.DrawText(str
, x
, y
);
6750 if (attr
.HasTextEffects() && (attr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_STRIKETHROUGH
))
6752 wxPen oldPen
= dc
.GetPen();
6753 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(attr
.GetTextColour(), 1));
6754 dc
.DrawLine(x
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5), x
+w
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5));
6755 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, oldPen
);
6764 /// Lay the item out
6765 bool wxRichTextPlainText::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(rect
), const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(parentRect
), int WXUNUSED(style
))
6767 // Only lay out if we haven't already cached the size
6769 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), m_size
, m_descent
, dc
, context
, 0, wxPoint(0, 0));
6771 // Eventually we want to have a reasonable estimate of minimum size.
6772 m_minSize
= wxSize(0, 0);
6777 void wxRichTextPlainText::Copy(const wxRichTextPlainText
& obj
)
6779 wxRichTextObject::Copy(obj
);
6781 m_text
= obj
.m_text
;
6784 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
6785 /// is invalid for this object.
6786 bool wxRichTextPlainText::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int WXUNUSED(flags
), const wxPoint
& position
, const wxSize
& WXUNUSED(parentSize
), wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
6788 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
6791 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
6792 wxASSERT (para
!= NULL
);
6794 int relativeX
= position
.x
- GetParent()->GetPosition().x
;
6796 wxRichTextAttr
textAttr(para
? para
->GetCombinedAttributes(GetAttributes()) : GetAttributes());
6797 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(textAttr
, (wxRichTextObject
*) this);
6799 // Always assume unformatted text, since at this level we have no knowledge
6800 // of line breaks - and we don't need it, since we'll calculate size within
6801 // formatted text by doing it in chunks according to the line ranges
6803 bool bScript(false);
6804 wxFont
font(GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(textAttr
));
6807 if ( textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && ( (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUPERSCRIPT
)
6808 || (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUBSCRIPT
) ) )
6810 wxFont textFont
= font
;
6811 if (textFont
.IsUsingSizeInPixels())
6813 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPixelSize().y
) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
6814 textFont
.SetPixelSize(wxSize(0, static_cast<int>(size
)));
6818 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPointSize()) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
6819 textFont
.SetPointSize(static_cast<int>(size
));
6821 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
6824 else if (textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SMALL_CAPITALS
))
6826 wxFont textFont
= font
;
6827 textFont
.SetPointSize((int) (textFont
.GetPointSize()*0.75));
6828 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
6833 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
6837 bool haveDescent
= false;
6838 int startPos
= range
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart();
6839 long len
= range
.GetLength();
6841 wxString
str(m_text
);
6842 if (context
.HasVirtualText(this))
6844 if (!context
.GetVirtualText(this, str
) || str
.Length() != m_text
.Length())
6848 wxString toReplace
= wxRichTextLineBreakChar
;
6849 str
.Replace(toReplace
, wxT(" "));
6851 wxString stringChunk
= str
.Mid(startPos
, (size_t) len
);
6853 if (textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & (wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_CAPITALS
|wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SMALL_CAPITALS
)))
6854 stringChunk
.MakeUpper();
6858 if (stringChunk
.Find(wxT('\t')) != wxNOT_FOUND
)
6860 // the string has a tab
6861 wxArrayInt tabArray
;
6862 if (textAttr
.GetTabs().IsEmpty())
6863 tabArray
= wxRichTextParagraph::GetDefaultTabs();
6865 tabArray
= textAttr
.GetTabs();
6867 int tabCount
= tabArray
.GetCount();
6869 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
; ++i
)
6871 int pos
= tabArray
[i
];
6872 pos
= ((wxRichTextPlainText
*) this)->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, pos
);
6876 int nextTabPos
= -1;
6878 while (stringChunk
.Find(wxT('\t')) >= 0)
6880 int absoluteWidth
= 0;
6882 // the string has a tab
6883 // break up the string at the Tab
6884 wxString stringFragment
= stringChunk
.BeforeFirst(wxT('\t'));
6885 stringChunk
= stringChunk
.AfterFirst(wxT('\t'));
6890 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
6891 oldWidth
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
6895 // Add these partial extents
6897 dc
.GetPartialTextExtents(stringFragment
, p
);
6899 for (j
= 0; j
< p
.GetCount(); j
++)
6900 partialExtents
->Add(oldWidth
+ p
[j
]);
6902 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
6903 absoluteWidth
= (*partialExtents
)[(*partialExtents
).GetCount()-1] + relativeX
;
6905 absoluteWidth
= relativeX
;
6909 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment
, & w
, & h
);
6911 absoluteWidth
= width
+ relativeX
;
6915 bool notFound
= true;
6916 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
&& notFound
; ++i
)
6918 nextTabPos
= tabArray
.Item(i
);
6920 // Find the next tab position.
6921 // Even if we're at the end of the tab array, we must still process the chunk.
6923 if (nextTabPos
> absoluteWidth
|| (i
== (tabCount
- 1)))
6925 if (nextTabPos
<= absoluteWidth
)
6927 int defaultTabWidth
= ((wxRichTextPlainText
*) this)->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, WIDTH_FOR_DEFAULT_TABS
);
6928 nextTabPos
= absoluteWidth
+ defaultTabWidth
;
6932 width
= nextTabPos
- relativeX
;
6935 partialExtents
->Add(width
);
6941 if (!stringChunk
.IsEmpty())
6946 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
6947 oldWidth
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
6951 // Add these partial extents
6953 dc
.GetPartialTextExtents(stringChunk
, p
);
6955 for (j
= 0; j
< p
.GetCount(); j
++)
6956 partialExtents
->Add(oldWidth
+ p
[j
]);
6960 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringChunk
, & w
, & h
, & descent
);
6968 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
6969 if ((*partialExtents
).GetCount() > 0)
6970 w
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
6973 size
= wxSize(w
, charHeight
);
6977 size
= wxSize(width
, dc
.GetCharHeight());
6981 dc
.GetTextExtent(wxT("X"), & w
, & h
, & descent
);
6989 /// Do a split, returning an object containing the second part, and setting
6990 /// the first part in 'this'.
6991 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextPlainText::DoSplit(long pos
)
6993 long index
= pos
- GetRange().GetStart();
6995 if (index
< 0 || index
>= (int) m_text
.length())
6998 wxString firstPart
= m_text
.Mid(0, index
);
6999 wxString secondPart
= m_text
.Mid(index
);
7003 wxRichTextPlainText
* newObject
= new wxRichTextPlainText(secondPart
);
7004 newObject
->SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
7005 newObject
->SetProperties(GetProperties());
7007 newObject
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, GetRange().GetEnd()));
7008 GetRange().SetEnd(pos
-1);
7014 void wxRichTextPlainText::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
7016 end
= start
+ m_text
.length() - 1;
7017 m_range
.SetRange(start
, end
);
7021 bool wxRichTextPlainText::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
7023 wxRichTextRange r
= range
;
7025 r
.LimitTo(GetRange());
7027 if (r
.GetStart() == GetRange().GetStart() && r
.GetEnd() == GetRange().GetEnd())
7033 long startIndex
= r
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart();
7034 long len
= r
.GetLength();
7036 m_text
= m_text
.Mid(0, startIndex
) + m_text
.Mid(startIndex
+len
);
7040 /// Get text for the given range.
7041 wxString
wxRichTextPlainText::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
7043 wxRichTextRange r
= range
;
7045 r
.LimitTo(GetRange());
7047 long startIndex
= r
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart();
7048 long len
= r
.GetLength();
7050 return m_text
.Mid(startIndex
, len
);
7053 /// Returns true if this object can merge itself with the given one.
7054 bool wxRichTextPlainText::CanMerge(wxRichTextObject
* object
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
) const
7057 if (!context
.GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
7059 return object
->GetClassInfo() == wxCLASSINFO(wxRichTextPlainText
) &&
7060 (m_text
.empty() || (wxTextAttrEq(GetAttributes(), object
->GetAttributes()) && m_properties
== object
->GetProperties()));
7064 wxRichTextPlainText
* otherObj
= wxDynamicCast(object
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
7065 if (!otherObj
|| m_text
.empty())
7068 if (!wxTextAttrEq(GetAttributes(), object
->GetAttributes()) || !(m_properties
== object
->GetProperties()))
7071 // Check if differing virtual attributes makes it impossible to merge
7074 bool hasVirtualAttr1
= context
.HasVirtualAttributes((wxRichTextObject
*) this);
7075 bool hasVirtualAttr2
= context
.HasVirtualAttributes((wxRichTextObject
*) object
);
7076 if (!hasVirtualAttr1
&& !hasVirtualAttr2
)
7078 else if (hasVirtualAttr1
!= hasVirtualAttr2
)
7082 wxRichTextAttr virtualAttr1
= context
.GetVirtualAttributes((wxRichTextObject
*) this);
7083 wxRichTextAttr virtualAttr2
= context
.GetVirtualAttributes((wxRichTextObject
*) object
);
7084 return virtualAttr1
== virtualAttr2
;
7089 /// Returns true if this object merged itself with the given one.
7090 /// The calling code will then delete the given object.
7091 bool wxRichTextPlainText::Merge(wxRichTextObject
* object
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& WXUNUSED(context
))
7093 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObject
= wxDynamicCast(object
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
7094 wxASSERT( textObject
!= NULL
);
7098 m_text
+= textObject
->GetText();
7099 wxRichTextApplyStyle(m_attributes
, textObject
->GetAttributes());
7106 bool wxRichTextPlainText::CanSplit(wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
) const
7108 // If this object has any virtual attributes at all, whether for the whole object
7109 // or individual ones, we should try splitting it by calling Split.
7110 // Must be more than one character in order to be able to split.
7111 return m_text
.Length() > 1 && context
.HasVirtualAttributes((wxRichTextObject
*) this);
7114 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextPlainText::Split(wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
)
7116 int count
= context
.GetVirtualSubobjectAttributesCount(this);
7117 if (count
> 0 && GetParent())
7119 wxRichTextCompositeObject
* parent
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextCompositeObject
);
7120 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= parent
->GetChildren().Find(this);
7123 const wxRichTextAttr emptyAttr
;
7124 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
7126 wxArrayInt positions
;
7127 wxRichTextAttrArray attributes
;
7128 if (context
.GetVirtualSubobjectAttributes(this, positions
, attributes
) && positions
.GetCount() > 0)
7130 wxASSERT(positions
.GetCount() == attributes
.GetCount());
7132 // We will gather up runs of text with the same virtual attributes
7134 int len
= m_text
.Length();
7137 // runStart and runEnd represent the accumulated run with a consistent attribute
7138 // that hasn't yet been appended
7141 wxRichTextAttr currentAttr
;
7142 wxString text
= m_text
;
7143 wxRichTextPlainText
* lastPlainText
= this;
7145 for (i
= 0; i
< (int) positions
.GetCount(); i
++)
7147 int pos
= positions
[i
];
7148 wxASSERT(pos
>= 0 && pos
< len
);
7149 if (pos
>= 0 && pos
< len
)
7151 const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
= attributes
[i
];
7158 // Check if there was a gap from the last known attribute and this.
7159 // In that case, we need to do something with the span of non-attributed text.
7160 else if ((pos
-1) > runEnd
)
7164 // We hadn't processed anything previously, so the previous run is from the text start
7165 // to just before this position. The current attribute remains empty.
7171 // If the previous attribute matches the gap's attribute (i.e., no attributes)
7172 // then just extend the run.
7173 if (currentAttr
.IsDefault())
7179 // We need to add an object, or reuse the existing one.
7182 lastPlainText
= this;
7183 SetText(text
.Mid(runStart
, runEnd
- runStart
+ 1));
7187 wxRichTextPlainText
* obj
= new wxRichTextPlainText
;
7188 lastPlainText
= obj
;
7189 obj
->SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
7190 obj
->SetProperties(GetProperties());
7191 obj
->SetParent(parent
);
7193 obj
->SetText(text
.Mid(runStart
, runEnd
- runStart
+ 1));
7195 parent
->GetChildren().Insert(next
, obj
);
7197 parent
->GetChildren().Append(obj
);
7200 runStart
= runEnd
+1;
7203 currentAttr
= emptyAttr
;
7208 wxASSERT(runEnd
== pos
-1);
7210 // Now we only have to deal with the previous run
7211 if (currentAttr
== attr
)
7213 // If we still have the same attributes, then we
7214 // simply increase the run size.
7221 // We need to add an object, or reuse the existing one.
7224 lastPlainText
= this;
7225 SetText(text
.Mid(runStart
, runEnd
- runStart
+ 1));
7229 wxRichTextPlainText
* obj
= new wxRichTextPlainText
;
7230 lastPlainText
= obj
;
7231 obj
->SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
7232 obj
->SetProperties(GetProperties());
7233 obj
->SetParent(parent
);
7235 obj
->SetText(text
.Mid(runStart
, runEnd
- runStart
+ 1));
7237 parent
->GetChildren().Insert(next
, obj
);
7239 parent
->GetChildren().Append(obj
);
7251 // We may still have a run to add, and possibly a no-attribute text fragment after that.
7252 // If the whole string was already a single attribute (the run covers the whole string), don't split.
7253 if ((runStart
!= -1) && !(runStart
== 0 && runEnd
== (len
-1)))
7255 // If the current attribute is empty, merge the run with the next fragment
7256 // which by definition (because it's not specified) has empty attributes.
7257 if (currentAttr
.IsDefault())
7260 if (runEnd
< (len
-1))
7262 // We need to add an object, or reuse the existing one.
7265 lastPlainText
= this;
7266 SetText(text
.Mid(runStart
, runEnd
- runStart
+ 1));
7270 wxRichTextPlainText
* obj
= new wxRichTextPlainText
;
7271 lastPlainText
= obj
;
7272 obj
->SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
7273 obj
->SetProperties(GetProperties());
7274 obj
->SetParent(parent
);
7276 obj
->SetText(text
.Mid(runStart
, runEnd
- runStart
+ 1));
7278 parent
->GetChildren().Insert(next
, obj
);
7280 parent
->GetChildren().Append(obj
);
7283 runStart
= runEnd
+1;
7287 // Now the last, non-attributed fragment at the end, if any
7288 if ((runStart
< len
) && !(runStart
== 0 && runEnd
== (len
-1)))
7290 wxASSERT(runStart
!= 0);
7292 wxRichTextPlainText
* obj
= new wxRichTextPlainText
;
7293 obj
->SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
7294 obj
->SetProperties(GetProperties());
7295 obj
->SetParent(parent
);
7297 obj
->SetText(text
.Mid(runStart
, runEnd
- runStart
+ 1));
7299 parent
->GetChildren().Insert(next
, obj
);
7301 parent
->GetChildren().Append(obj
);
7303 lastPlainText
= obj
;
7307 return lastPlainText
;
7314 /// Dump to output stream for debugging
7315 void wxRichTextPlainText::Dump(wxTextOutputStream
& stream
)
7317 wxRichTextObject::Dump(stream
);
7318 stream
<< m_text
<< wxT("\n");
7321 /// Get the first position from pos that has a line break character.
7322 long wxRichTextPlainText::GetFirstLineBreakPosition(long pos
)
7325 int len
= m_text
.length();
7326 int startPos
= pos
- m_range
.GetStart();
7327 for (i
= startPos
; i
< len
; i
++)
7329 wxChar ch
= m_text
[i
];
7330 if (ch
== wxRichTextLineBreakChar
)
7332 return i
+ m_range
.GetStart();
7340 * This is a kind of box, used to represent the whole buffer
7343 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextBuffer
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
)
7345 wxList
wxRichTextBuffer::sm_handlers
;
7346 wxList
wxRichTextBuffer::sm_drawingHandlers
;
7347 wxRichTextFieldTypeHashMap
wxRichTextBuffer::sm_fieldTypes
;
7348 wxRichTextRenderer
* wxRichTextBuffer::sm_renderer
= NULL
;
7349 int wxRichTextBuffer::sm_bulletRightMargin
= 20;
7350 float wxRichTextBuffer::sm_bulletProportion
= (float) 0.3;
7351 bool wxRichTextBuffer::sm_floatingLayoutMode
= true;
7354 void wxRichTextBuffer::Init()
7356 m_commandProcessor
= new wxCommandProcessor
;
7357 m_styleSheet
= NULL
;
7359 m_batchedCommandDepth
= 0;
7360 m_batchedCommand
= NULL
;
7364 m_dimensionScale
= 1.0;
7370 wxRichTextBuffer::~wxRichTextBuffer()
7372 delete m_commandProcessor
;
7373 delete m_batchedCommand
;
7376 ClearEventHandlers();
7379 void wxRichTextBuffer::ResetAndClearCommands()
7383 GetCommandProcessor()->ClearCommands();
7386 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
7389 void wxRichTextBuffer::Copy(const wxRichTextBuffer
& obj
)
7391 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Copy(obj
);
7393 m_styleSheet
= obj
.m_styleSheet
;
7394 m_modified
= obj
.m_modified
;
7395 m_batchedCommandDepth
= 0;
7396 if (m_batchedCommand
)
7397 delete m_batchedCommand
;
7398 m_batchedCommand
= NULL
;
7399 m_suppressUndo
= obj
.m_suppressUndo
;
7400 m_invalidRange
= obj
.m_invalidRange
;
7401 m_dimensionScale
= obj
.m_dimensionScale
;
7402 m_fontScale
= obj
.m_fontScale
;
7405 /// Push style sheet to top of stack
7406 bool wxRichTextBuffer::PushStyleSheet(wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
)
7409 styleSheet
->InsertSheet(m_styleSheet
);
7411 SetStyleSheet(styleSheet
);
7416 /// Pop style sheet from top of stack
7417 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* wxRichTextBuffer::PopStyleSheet()
7421 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* oldSheet
= m_styleSheet
;
7422 m_styleSheet
= oldSheet
->GetNextSheet();
7431 /// Submit command to insert paragraphs
7432 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertParagraphsWithUndo(long pos
, const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& paragraphs
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
7434 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertParagraphsWithUndo(this, pos
, paragraphs
, ctrl
, flags
);
7437 /// Submit command to insert paragraphs
7438 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertParagraphsWithUndo(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& paragraphs
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
7440 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Text"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
7442 action
->GetNewParagraphs() = paragraphs
;
7444 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
7446 wxRichTextRange range
= wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
+ paragraphs
.GetOwnRange().GetEnd() - 1);
7447 if (!paragraphs
.GetPartialParagraph())
7448 range
.SetEnd(range
.GetEnd()+1);
7450 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
7451 action
->SetRange(range
);
7453 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7458 /// Submit command to insert the given text
7459 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertTextWithUndo(long pos
, const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
7462 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertTextWithUndo(this, pos
, text
, ctrl
, flags
);
7464 return wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertTextWithUndo(this, pos
, text
, ctrl
, flags
);
7467 /// Submit command to insert the given text
7468 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertTextWithUndo(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
7470 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Text"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
7472 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
7473 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
7474 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
7476 // Get appropriate paragraph style
7477 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
, false, false);
7478 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
7482 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AddParagraphs(text
, p
);
7484 int length
= action
->GetNewParagraphs().GetOwnRange().GetLength();
7486 if (!text
.empty() && text
.Last() != wxT('\n'))
7488 // Don't count the newline when undoing
7490 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
7492 else if (!text
.empty() && text
.Last() == wxT('\n'))
7495 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
7497 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
7498 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
+ length
- 1));
7500 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7505 /// Submit command to insert the given text
7506 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertNewlineWithUndo(long pos
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
7508 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertNewlineWithUndo(this, pos
, ctrl
, flags
);
7511 /// Submit command to insert the given text
7512 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertNewlineWithUndo(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
7514 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Text"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
7516 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
7517 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
7518 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
7520 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
, false, true /* look for next paragraph style */);
7521 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
7525 wxRichTextAttr
attr(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
7526 // Don't include box attributes such as margins
7527 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
7529 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(wxEmptyString
, this, & attr
);
7530 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
7531 action
->GetNewParagraphs().UpdateRanges();
7532 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(false);
7533 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(pos
, false);
7537 newPara
->SetAttributes(*p
);
7539 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_INTERACTIVE
)
7541 if (para
&& para
->GetRange().GetEnd() == pos
)
7544 // Now see if we need to number the paragraph.
7545 if (newPara
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
7547 wxRichTextAttr numberingAttr
;
7548 if (FindNextParagraphNumber(para
, numberingAttr
))
7549 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), (const wxRichTextAttr
&) numberingAttr
);
7553 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
7555 // Use the default character style
7556 if (!buffer
->GetDefaultStyle().IsDefault() && newPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst())
7558 // Check whether the default style merely reflects the paragraph/basic style,
7559 // in which case don't apply it.
7560 wxRichTextAttr
defaultStyle(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
7561 defaultStyle
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
7562 wxRichTextAttr toApply
;
7565 wxRichTextAttr combinedAttr
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(true /* include box attributes */);
7566 wxRichTextAttr newAttr
;
7567 // This filters out attributes that are accounted for by the current
7568 // paragraph/basic style
7569 wxRichTextApplyStyle(toApply
, defaultStyle
, & combinedAttr
);
7572 toApply
= defaultStyle
;
7574 if (!toApply
.IsDefault())
7575 newPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData()->SetAttributes(toApply
);
7578 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
7579 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos1
, pos1
));
7581 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7586 /// Submit command to insert the given image
7587 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertImageWithUndo(long pos
, const wxRichTextImageBlock
& imageBlock
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
,
7588 const wxRichTextAttr
& textAttr
)
7590 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertImageWithUndo(this, pos
, imageBlock
, ctrl
, flags
, textAttr
);
7593 /// Submit command to insert the given image
7594 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertImageWithUndo(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, const wxRichTextImageBlock
& imageBlock
,
7595 wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
,
7596 const wxRichTextAttr
& textAttr
)
7598 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Image"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
7600 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
7601 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
7602 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
7604 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
);
7605 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
7609 wxRichTextAttr
attr(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
7611 // Don't include box attributes such as margins
7612 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
7614 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(this, & attr
);
7616 newPara
->SetAttributes(*p
);
7618 wxRichTextImage
* imageObject
= new wxRichTextImage(imageBlock
, newPara
);
7619 newPara
->AppendChild(imageObject
);
7620 imageObject
->SetAttributes(textAttr
);
7621 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
7622 action
->GetNewParagraphs().UpdateRanges();
7624 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
7626 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
7628 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
7629 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
));
7631 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7636 // Insert an object with no change of it
7637 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextBuffer::InsertObjectWithUndo(long pos
, wxRichTextObject
*object
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
7639 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertObjectWithUndo(this, pos
, object
, ctrl
, flags
);
7642 // Insert an object with no change of it
7643 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertObjectWithUndo(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, wxRichTextObject
*object
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
7645 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Object"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
7647 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
7648 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
7649 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
7651 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
);
7652 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
7656 wxRichTextAttr
attr(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
7658 // Don't include box attributes such as margins
7659 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
7661 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(this, & attr
);
7663 newPara
->SetAttributes(*p
);
7665 newPara
->AppendChild(object
);
7666 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
7667 action
->GetNewParagraphs().UpdateRanges();
7669 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
7671 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
7673 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
7674 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
));
7676 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7678 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= GetLeafObjectAtPosition(pos
);
7682 wxRichTextField
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertFieldWithUndo(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, const wxString
& fieldType
,
7683 const wxRichTextProperties
& properties
,
7684 wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
,
7685 const wxRichTextAttr
& textAttr
)
7687 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Field"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
7689 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
7690 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
7691 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
7693 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
);
7694 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
7698 wxRichTextAttr
attr(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
7700 // Don't include box attributes such as margins
7701 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
7703 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(this, & attr
);
7705 newPara
->SetAttributes(*p
);
7707 wxRichTextField
* fieldObject
= new wxRichTextField();
7708 fieldObject
->wxRichTextObject::SetProperties(properties
);
7709 fieldObject
->SetFieldType(fieldType
);
7710 fieldObject
->SetAttributes(textAttr
);
7711 newPara
->AppendChild(fieldObject
);
7712 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
7713 action
->GetNewParagraphs().UpdateRanges();
7714 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
7715 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
7717 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
7718 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
));
7720 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7722 wxRichTextField
* obj
= wxDynamicCast(GetLeafObjectAtPosition(pos
), wxRichTextField
);
7726 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetObjectPropertiesWithUndo(wxRichTextObject
& obj
, const wxRichTextProperties
& properties
, wxRichTextObject
* objToSet
)
7728 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
7729 wxCHECK_MSG(buffer
, false, wxT("Invalid buffer"));
7730 wxRichTextCtrl
* rtc
= buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl();
7731 wxCHECK_MSG(rtc
, false, wxT("Invalid rtc"));
7733 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
7734 wxRichTextObject
* clone
= NULL
;
7736 // The object on which to set properties will usually be 'obj', but use objToSet if it's valid.
7737 // This is necessary e.g. on setting a wxRichTextCell's properties, when obj will be the parent table
7738 if (objToSet
== NULL
)
7741 if (rtc
->SuppressingUndo())
7742 objToSet
->SetProperties(properties
);
7745 clone
= obj
.Clone();
7746 objToSet
->SetProperties(properties
);
7748 // The 'true' parameter in the next line says "Ignore first time"; otherwise the objects are prematurely switched
7749 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change Properties"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
, buffer
, obj
.GetParentContainer(), rtc
, true);
7750 action
->SetOldAndNewObjects(& obj
, clone
);
7751 action
->SetPosition(obj
.GetRange().GetStart());
7752 action
->SetRange(obj
.GetRange());
7753 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7759 /// Get the style that is appropriate for a new paragraph at this position.
7760 /// If the previous paragraph has a paragraph style name, look up the next-paragraph
7762 wxRichTextAttr
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyleForNewParagraph(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, bool caretPosition
, bool lookUpNewParaStyle
) const
7764 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(pos
, caretPosition
);
7767 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7768 bool foundAttributes
= false;
7770 // Look for a matching paragraph style
7771 if (lookUpNewParaStyle
&& !para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
7773 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* paraDef
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
7776 // If we're not at the end of the paragraph, then we apply THIS style, and not the designated next style.
7777 if (para
->GetRange().GetEnd() == pos
&& !paraDef
->GetNextStyle().IsEmpty())
7779 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* nextParaDef
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(paraDef
->GetNextStyle());
7782 foundAttributes
= true;
7783 attr
= nextParaDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet());
7787 // If we didn't find the 'next style', use this style instead.
7788 if (!foundAttributes
)
7790 foundAttributes
= true;
7791 attr
= paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet());
7796 // Also apply list style if present
7797 if (lookUpNewParaStyle
&& !para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
7799 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* listDef
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
7802 int thisIndent
= para
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
7803 int thisLevel
= para
->GetAttributes().HasOutlineLevel() ? para
->GetAttributes().GetOutlineLevel() : listDef
->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent
);
7805 // Apply the overall list style, and item style for this level
7806 wxRichTextAttr
listStyle(listDef
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(thisLevel
, buffer
->GetStyleSheet()));
7807 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, listStyle
);
7808 attr
.SetOutlineLevel(thisLevel
);
7809 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
7810 attr
.SetBulletNumber(para
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber());
7814 if (!foundAttributes
)
7816 attr
= para
->GetAttributes();
7817 int flags
= attr
.GetFlags();
7819 // Eliminate character styles
7820 flags
&= ( (~ wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT
) |
7821 (~ wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
) |
7822 (~ wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
) );
7823 attr
.SetFlags(flags
);
7829 return wxRichTextAttr();
7832 /// Submit command to delete this range
7833 bool wxRichTextBuffer::DeleteRangeWithUndo(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
)
7835 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->DeleteRangeWithUndo(range
, ctrl
, this);
7838 /// Submit command to delete this range
7839 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DeleteRangeWithUndo(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
7841 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Delete"), wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
, buffer
, this, ctrl
);
7843 action
->SetPosition(ctrl
->GetCaretPosition());
7845 // Set the range to delete
7846 action
->SetRange(range
);
7848 // Copy the fragment that we'll need to restore in Undo
7849 CopyFragment(range
, action
->GetOldParagraphs());
7851 // See if we're deleting a paragraph marker, in which case we need to
7852 // make a note not to copy the attributes from the 2nd paragraph to the 1st.
7853 if (range
.GetStart() == range
.GetEnd())
7855 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(range
.GetStart());
7856 if (para
&& para
->GetRange().GetEnd() == range
.GetEnd())
7858 wxRichTextParagraph
* nextPara
= GetParagraphAtPosition(range
.GetStart()+1);
7859 if (nextPara
&& nextPara
!= para
)
7861 action
->GetOldParagraphs().GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData()->SetAttributes(nextPara
->GetAttributes());
7862 action
->GetOldParagraphs().GetAttributes().SetFlags(action
->GetOldParagraphs().GetAttributes().GetFlags() | wxTEXT_ATTR_KEEP_FIRST_PARA_STYLE
);
7867 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
7872 /// Collapse undo/redo commands
7873 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginBatchUndo(const wxString
& cmdName
)
7875 if (m_batchedCommandDepth
== 0)
7877 wxASSERT(m_batchedCommand
== NULL
);
7878 if (m_batchedCommand
)
7880 GetCommandProcessor()->Store(m_batchedCommand
);
7882 m_batchedCommand
= new wxRichTextCommand(cmdName
);
7885 m_batchedCommandDepth
++;
7890 /// Collapse undo/redo commands
7891 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndBatchUndo()
7893 m_batchedCommandDepth
--;
7895 wxASSERT(m_batchedCommandDepth
>= 0);
7896 wxASSERT(m_batchedCommand
!= NULL
);
7898 if (m_batchedCommandDepth
== 0)
7900 GetCommandProcessor()->Store(m_batchedCommand
);
7901 m_batchedCommand
= NULL
;
7907 /// Submit immediately, or delay according to whether collapsing is on
7908 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SubmitAction(wxRichTextAction
* action
)
7910 if (action
&& !action
->GetNewParagraphs().IsEmpty())
7911 PrepareContent(action
->GetNewParagraphs());
7913 if (BatchingUndo() && m_batchedCommand
&& !SuppressingUndo())
7915 if (!action
->GetIgnoreFirstTime())
7917 wxRichTextCommand
* cmd
= new wxRichTextCommand(action
->GetName());
7918 cmd
->AddAction(action
);
7920 cmd
->GetActions().Clear();
7924 m_batchedCommand
->AddAction(action
);
7928 wxRichTextCommand
* cmd
= new wxRichTextCommand(action
->GetName());
7929 cmd
->AddAction(action
);
7931 // Only store it if we're not suppressing undo.
7932 if (!action
->GetIgnoreFirstTime())
7934 return GetCommandProcessor()->Submit(cmd
, !SuppressingUndo());
7936 else if (!SuppressingUndo())
7938 GetCommandProcessor()->Store(cmd
); // Just store it, without Do()ing anything
7945 /// Begin suppressing undo/redo commands.
7946 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginSuppressUndo()
7953 /// End suppressing undo/redo commands.
7954 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndSuppressUndo()
7961 /// Begin using a style
7962 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginStyle(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
7964 wxRichTextAttr
newStyle(GetDefaultStyle());
7965 newStyle
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
7967 // Save the old default style
7968 m_attributeStack
.Append((wxObject
*) new wxRichTextAttr(newStyle
));
7970 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newStyle
, style
);
7971 newStyle
.SetFlags(style
.GetFlags()|newStyle
.GetFlags());
7973 SetDefaultStyle(newStyle
);
7979 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndStyle()
7981 if (!m_attributeStack
.GetFirst())
7983 wxLogDebug(_("Too many EndStyle calls!"));
7987 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_attributeStack
.GetLast();
7988 wxRichTextAttr
* attr
= (wxRichTextAttr
*)node
->GetData();
7989 m_attributeStack
.Erase(node
);
7991 SetDefaultStyle(*attr
);
7998 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndAllStyles()
8000 while (m_attributeStack
.GetCount() != 0)
8005 /// Clear the style stack
8006 void wxRichTextBuffer::ClearStyleStack()
8008 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_attributeStack
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
8009 delete (wxRichTextAttr
*) node
->GetData();
8010 m_attributeStack
.Clear();
8013 /// Begin using bold
8014 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginBold()
8016 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8017 attr
.SetFontWeight(wxFONTWEIGHT_BOLD
);
8019 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8022 /// Begin using italic
8023 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginItalic()
8025 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8026 attr
.SetFontStyle(wxFONTSTYLE_ITALIC
);
8028 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8031 /// Begin using underline
8032 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginUnderline()
8034 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8035 attr
.SetFontUnderlined(true);
8037 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8040 /// Begin using point size
8041 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginFontSize(int pointSize
)
8043 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8044 attr
.SetFontSize(pointSize
);
8046 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8049 /// Begin using this font
8050 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginFont(const wxFont
& font
)
8052 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8055 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8058 /// Begin using this colour
8059 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginTextColour(const wxColour
& colour
)
8061 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8062 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
8063 attr
.SetTextColour(colour
);
8065 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8068 /// Begin using alignment
8069 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginAlignment(wxTextAttrAlignment alignment
)
8071 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8072 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
8073 attr
.SetAlignment(alignment
);
8075 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8078 /// Begin left indent
8079 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginLeftIndent(int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
)
8081 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8082 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
8083 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
8085 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8088 /// Begin right indent
8089 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginRightIndent(int rightIndent
)
8091 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8092 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
8093 attr
.SetRightIndent(rightIndent
);
8095 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8098 /// Begin paragraph spacing
8099 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginParagraphSpacing(int before
, int after
)
8103 flags
|= wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
;
8105 flags
|= wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
;
8107 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8108 attr
.SetFlags(flags
);
8109 attr
.SetParagraphSpacingBefore(before
);
8110 attr
.SetParagraphSpacingAfter(after
);
8112 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8115 /// Begin line spacing
8116 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginLineSpacing(int lineSpacing
)
8118 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8119 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
8120 attr
.SetLineSpacing(lineSpacing
);
8122 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8125 /// Begin numbered bullet
8126 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginNumberedBullet(int bulletNumber
, int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
, int bulletStyle
)
8128 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8129 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
8130 attr
.SetBulletStyle(bulletStyle
);
8131 attr
.SetBulletNumber(bulletNumber
);
8132 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
8134 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8137 /// Begin symbol bullet
8138 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginSymbolBullet(const wxString
& symbol
, int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
, int bulletStyle
)
8140 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8141 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
8142 attr
.SetBulletStyle(bulletStyle
);
8143 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
8144 attr
.SetBulletText(symbol
);
8146 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8149 /// Begin standard bullet
8150 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginStandardBullet(const wxString
& bulletName
, int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
, int bulletStyle
)
8152 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8153 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
8154 attr
.SetBulletStyle(bulletStyle
);
8155 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
8156 attr
.SetBulletName(bulletName
);
8158 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8161 /// Begin named character style
8162 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginCharacterStyle(const wxString
& characterStyle
)
8164 if (GetStyleSheet())
8166 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindCharacterStyle(characterStyle
);
8169 wxRichTextAttr attr
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
8170 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8176 /// Begin named paragraph style
8177 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginParagraphStyle(const wxString
& paragraphStyle
)
8179 if (GetStyleSheet())
8181 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(paragraphStyle
);
8184 wxRichTextAttr attr
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
8185 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8191 /// Begin named list style
8192 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginListStyle(const wxString
& listStyle
, int level
, int number
)
8194 if (GetStyleSheet())
8196 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(listStyle
);
8199 wxRichTextAttr
attr(def
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(level
));
8201 attr
.SetBulletNumber(number
);
8203 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8210 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginURL(const wxString
& url
, const wxString
& characterStyle
)
8212 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8214 if (!characterStyle
.IsEmpty() && GetStyleSheet())
8216 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindCharacterStyle(characterStyle
);
8219 attr
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
8224 return BeginStyle(attr
);
8227 /// Adds a handler to the end
8228 void wxRichTextBuffer::AddHandler(wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
)
8230 sm_handlers
.Append(handler
);
8233 /// Inserts a handler at the front
8234 void wxRichTextBuffer::InsertHandler(wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
)
8236 sm_handlers
.Insert( handler
);
8239 /// Removes a handler
8240 bool wxRichTextBuffer::RemoveHandler(const wxString
& name
)
8242 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= FindHandler(name
);
8245 sm_handlers
.DeleteObject(handler
);
8253 /// Finds a handler by filename or, if supplied, type
8254 wxRichTextFileHandler
*wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandlerFilenameOrType(const wxString
& filename
,
8255 wxRichTextFileType imageType
)
8257 if (imageType
!= wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_ANY
)
8258 return FindHandler(imageType
);
8259 else if (!filename
.IsEmpty())
8261 wxString path
, file
, ext
;
8262 wxFileName::SplitPath(filename
, & path
, & file
, & ext
);
8263 return FindHandler(ext
, imageType
);
8270 /// Finds a handler by name
8271 wxRichTextFileHandler
* wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandler(const wxString
& name
)
8273 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
8276 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
8277 if (handler
->GetName().Lower() == name
.Lower()) return handler
;
8279 node
= node
->GetNext();
8284 /// Finds a handler by extension and type
8285 wxRichTextFileHandler
* wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandler(const wxString
& extension
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
8287 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
8290 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
8291 if ( handler
->GetExtension().Lower() == extension
.Lower() &&
8292 (type
== wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_ANY
|| handler
->GetType() == type
) )
8294 node
= node
->GetNext();
8299 /// Finds a handler by type
8300 wxRichTextFileHandler
* wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandler(wxRichTextFileType type
)
8302 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
8305 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
8306 if (handler
->GetType() == type
) return handler
;
8307 node
= node
->GetNext();
8312 void wxRichTextBuffer::InitStandardHandlers()
8314 if (!FindHandler(wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_TEXT
))
8315 AddHandler(new wxRichTextPlainTextHandler
);
8318 void wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpHandlers()
8320 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
8323 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
8324 wxList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
8329 sm_handlers
.Clear();
8332 wxString
wxRichTextBuffer::GetExtWildcard(bool combine
, bool save
, wxArrayInt
* types
)
8339 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= GetHandlers().GetFirst();
8343 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*) node
->GetData();
8344 if (handler
->IsVisible() && ((save
&& handler
->CanSave()) || (!save
&& handler
->CanLoad())))
8349 wildcard
+= wxT(";");
8350 wildcard
+= wxT("*.") + handler
->GetExtension();
8355 wildcard
+= wxT("|");
8356 wildcard
+= handler
->GetName();
8357 wildcard
+= wxT(" ");
8358 wildcard
+= _("files");
8359 wildcard
+= wxT(" (*.");
8360 wildcard
+= handler
->GetExtension();
8361 wildcard
+= wxT(")|*.");
8362 wildcard
+= handler
->GetExtension();
8364 types
->Add(handler
->GetType());
8369 node
= node
->GetNext();
8373 wildcard
= wxT("(") + wildcard
+ wxT(")|") + wildcard
;
8377 #if wxUSE_FFILE && wxUSE_STREAMS
8379 bool wxRichTextBuffer::LoadFile(const wxString
& filename
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
8381 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandlerFilenameOrType(filename
, type
);
8384 SetDefaultStyle(wxRichTextAttr());
8385 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
8386 bool success
= handler
->LoadFile(this, filename
);
8387 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
8395 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SaveFile(const wxString
& filename
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
8397 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandlerFilenameOrType(filename
, type
);
8400 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
8401 return handler
->SaveFile(this, filename
);
8406 #endif // wxUSE_FFILE && wxUSE_STREAMS
8409 /// Load from a stream
8410 bool wxRichTextBuffer::LoadFile(wxInputStream
& stream
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
8412 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandler(type
);
8415 SetDefaultStyle(wxRichTextAttr());
8416 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
8417 bool success
= handler
->LoadFile(this, stream
);
8418 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
8425 /// Save to a stream
8426 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SaveFile(wxOutputStream
& stream
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
8428 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandler(type
);
8431 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
8432 return handler
->SaveFile(this, stream
);
8437 #endif // wxUSE_STREAMS
8439 /// Copy the range to the clipboard
8440 bool wxRichTextBuffer::CopyToClipboard(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
8442 bool success
= false;
8443 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= this;
8444 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
8445 container
= GetRichTextCtrl()->GetFocusObject();
8447 #if wxUSE_CLIPBOARD && wxUSE_DATAOBJ
8449 if (!wxTheClipboard
->IsOpened() && wxTheClipboard
->Open())
8451 wxTheClipboard
->Clear();
8453 // Add composite object
8455 wxDataObjectComposite
* compositeObject
= new wxDataObjectComposite();
8458 wxString text
= container
->GetTextForRange(range
);
8461 text
= wxTextFile::Translate(text
, wxTextFileType_Dos
);
8464 compositeObject
->Add(new wxTextDataObject(text
), false /* not preferred */);
8467 // Add rich text buffer data object. This needs the XML handler to be present.
8469 if (FindHandler(wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
8471 wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuf
= new wxRichTextBuffer
;
8472 container
->CopyFragment(range
, *richTextBuf
);
8474 compositeObject
->Add(new wxRichTextBufferDataObject(richTextBuf
), true /* preferred */);
8477 if (wxTheClipboard
->SetData(compositeObject
))
8480 wxTheClipboard
->Close();
8489 /// Paste the clipboard content to the buffer
8490 bool wxRichTextBuffer::PasteFromClipboard(long position
)
8492 bool success
= false;
8493 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= this;
8494 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
8495 container
= GetRichTextCtrl()->GetFocusObject();
8497 #if wxUSE_CLIPBOARD && wxUSE_DATAOBJ
8498 if (CanPasteFromClipboard())
8500 if (wxTheClipboard
->Open())
8502 if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDataFormat(wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetRichTextBufferFormatId())))
8504 wxRichTextBufferDataObject data
;
8505 wxTheClipboard
->GetData(data
);
8506 wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuffer
= data
.GetRichTextBuffer();
8509 container
->InsertParagraphsWithUndo(this, position
+1, *richTextBuffer
, GetRichTextCtrl(), 0);
8510 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
8511 GetRichTextCtrl()->ShowPosition(position
+ richTextBuffer
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
8512 delete richTextBuffer
;
8515 else if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_TEXT
)
8517 || wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_UNICODETEXT
)
8521 wxTextDataObject data
;
8522 wxTheClipboard
->GetData(data
);
8523 wxString
text(data
.GetText());
8526 text2
.Alloc(text
.Length()+1);
8528 for (i
= 0; i
< text
.Length(); i
++)
8530 wxChar ch
= text
[i
];
8531 if (ch
!= wxT('\r'))
8535 wxString text2
= text
;
8537 container
->InsertTextWithUndo(this, position
+1, text2
, GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
);
8539 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
8540 GetRichTextCtrl()->ShowPosition(position
+ text2
.Length());
8544 else if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_BITMAP
))
8546 wxBitmapDataObject data
;
8547 wxTheClipboard
->GetData(data
);
8548 wxBitmap
bitmap(data
.GetBitmap());
8549 wxImage
image(bitmap
.ConvertToImage());
8551 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Image"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, this, container
, GetRichTextCtrl(), false);
8553 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AddImage(image
);
8555 if (action
->GetNewParagraphs().GetChildCount() == 1)
8556 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
8558 action
->SetPosition(position
+1);
8560 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
8561 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(position
+1, position
+1));
8563 SubmitAction(action
);
8567 wxTheClipboard
->Close();
8571 wxUnusedVar(position
);
8576 /// Can we paste from the clipboard?
8577 bool wxRichTextBuffer::CanPasteFromClipboard() const
8579 bool canPaste
= false;
8580 #if wxUSE_CLIPBOARD && wxUSE_DATAOBJ
8581 if (!wxTheClipboard
->IsOpened() && wxTheClipboard
->Open())
8583 if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_TEXT
)
8585 || wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_UNICODETEXT
)
8587 || wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDataFormat(wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetRichTextBufferFormatId())) ||
8588 wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_BITMAP
))
8592 wxTheClipboard
->Close();
8598 /// Dumps contents of buffer for debugging purposes
8599 void wxRichTextBuffer::Dump()
8603 wxStringOutputStream
stream(& text
);
8604 wxTextOutputStream
textStream(stream
);
8611 /// Add an event handler
8612 bool wxRichTextBuffer::AddEventHandler(wxEvtHandler
* handler
)
8614 m_eventHandlers
.Append(handler
);
8618 /// Remove an event handler
8619 bool wxRichTextBuffer::RemoveEventHandler(wxEvtHandler
* handler
, bool deleteHandler
)
8621 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_eventHandlers
.Find(handler
);
8624 m_eventHandlers
.Erase(node
);
8634 /// Clear event handlers
8635 void wxRichTextBuffer::ClearEventHandlers()
8637 m_eventHandlers
.Clear();
8640 /// Send event to event handlers. If sendToAll is true, will send to all event handlers,
8641 /// otherwise will stop at the first successful one.
8642 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SendEvent(wxEvent
& event
, bool sendToAll
)
8644 bool success
= false;
8645 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_eventHandlers
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
8647 wxEvtHandler
* handler
= (wxEvtHandler
*) node
->GetData();
8648 if (handler
->ProcessEvent(event
))
8658 /// Set style sheet and notify of the change
8659 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SetStyleSheetAndNotify(wxRichTextStyleSheet
* sheet
)
8661 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* oldSheet
= GetStyleSheet();
8663 wxWindowID winid
= wxID_ANY
;
8664 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
8665 winid
= GetRichTextCtrl()->GetId();
8667 wxRichTextEvent
event(wxEVT_RICHTEXT_STYLESHEET_REPLACING
, winid
);
8668 event
.SetEventObject(GetRichTextCtrl());
8669 event
.SetContainer(GetRichTextCtrl()->GetFocusObject());
8670 event
.SetOldStyleSheet(oldSheet
);
8671 event
.SetNewStyleSheet(sheet
);
8674 if (SendEvent(event
) && !event
.IsAllowed())
8676 if (sheet
!= oldSheet
)
8682 if (oldSheet
&& oldSheet
!= sheet
)
8685 SetStyleSheet(sheet
);
8687 event
.SetEventType(wxEVT_RICHTEXT_STYLESHEET_REPLACED
);
8688 event
.SetOldStyleSheet(NULL
);
8691 return SendEvent(event
);
8694 /// Set renderer, deleting old one
8695 void wxRichTextBuffer::SetRenderer(wxRichTextRenderer
* renderer
)
8699 sm_renderer
= renderer
;
8702 /// Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
8703 /// information about position
8704 int wxRichTextBuffer::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
8706 int ret
= wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
8707 if (ret
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
8713 textPosition
= m_ownRange
.GetEnd()-1;
8716 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
|wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_OUTSIDE
;
8720 void wxRichTextBuffer::SetFontScale(double fontScale
)
8722 m_fontScale
= fontScale
;
8723 m_fontTable
.SetFontScale(fontScale
);
8726 void wxRichTextBuffer::SetDimensionScale(double dimScale
)
8728 m_dimensionScale
= dimScale
;
8731 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::DrawStandardBullet(wxRichTextParagraph
* paragraph
, wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextAttr
& bulletAttr
, const wxRect
& rect
)
8733 if (bulletAttr
.GetTextColour().IsOk())
8735 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(bulletAttr
.GetTextColour()));
8736 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, wxBrush(bulletAttr
.GetTextColour()));
8740 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, *wxBLACK_PEN
);
8741 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, *wxBLACK_BRUSH
);
8745 if (bulletAttr
.HasFont())
8747 font
= paragraph
->GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(bulletAttr
);
8750 font
= (*wxNORMAL_FONT
);
8752 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
8754 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
8756 int bulletWidth
= (int) (((float) charHeight
) * wxRichTextBuffer::GetBulletProportion());
8757 int bulletHeight
= bulletWidth
;
8761 // Calculate the top position of the character (as opposed to the whole line height)
8762 int y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
);
8764 // Calculate where the bullet should be positioned
8765 y
= y
+ (charHeight
+1)/2 - (bulletHeight
+1)/2;
8767 // The margin between a bullet and text.
8768 int margin
= paragraph
->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, wxRichTextBuffer::GetBulletRightMargin());
8770 if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_RIGHT
)
8771 x
= rect
.x
+ rect
.width
- bulletWidth
- margin
;
8772 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_CENTRE
)
8773 x
= x
+ (rect
.width
)/2 - bulletWidth
/2;
8775 if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/square"))
8777 dc
.DrawRectangle(x
, y
, bulletWidth
, bulletHeight
);
8779 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/diamond"))
8782 pts
[0].x
= x
; pts
[0].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
/2;
8783 pts
[1].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
/2; pts
[1].y
= y
;
8784 pts
[2].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
; pts
[2].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
/2;
8785 pts
[3].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
/2; pts
[3].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
;
8787 dc
.DrawPolygon(4, pts
);
8789 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/triangle"))
8792 pts
[0].x
= x
; pts
[0].y
= y
;
8793 pts
[1].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
; pts
[1].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
/2;
8794 pts
[2].x
= x
; pts
[2].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
;
8796 dc
.DrawPolygon(3, pts
);
8798 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/circle-outline"))
8800 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, *wxTRANSPARENT_BRUSH
);
8801 dc
.DrawEllipse(x
, y
, bulletWidth
, bulletHeight
);
8803 else // "standard/circle", and catch-all
8805 dc
.DrawEllipse(x
, y
, bulletWidth
, bulletHeight
);
8811 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::DrawTextBullet(wxRichTextParagraph
* paragraph
, wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxString
& text
)
8816 if ((attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_SYMBOL
) && !attr
.GetBulletFont().IsEmpty() && attr
.HasFont())
8818 wxRichTextAttr fontAttr
;
8819 if (attr
.HasFontPixelSize())
8820 fontAttr
.SetFontPixelSize(attr
.GetFontSize());
8822 fontAttr
.SetFontPointSize(attr
.GetFontSize());
8823 fontAttr
.SetFontStyle(attr
.GetFontStyle());
8824 fontAttr
.SetFontWeight(attr
.GetFontWeight());
8825 fontAttr
.SetFontUnderlined(attr
.GetFontUnderlined());
8826 fontAttr
.SetFontFaceName(attr
.GetBulletFont());
8827 font
= paragraph
->GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(fontAttr
);
8829 else if (attr
.HasFont())
8830 font
= paragraph
->GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(attr
);
8832 font
= (*wxNORMAL_FONT
);
8834 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
8836 if (attr
.GetTextColour().IsOk())
8837 dc
.SetTextForeground(attr
.GetTextColour());
8839 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
8841 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
8843 dc
.GetTextExtent(text
, & tw
, & th
);
8847 // Calculate the top position of the character (as opposed to the whole line height)
8848 int y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
);
8850 // The margin between a bullet and text.
8851 int margin
= paragraph
->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, wxRichTextBuffer::GetBulletRightMargin());
8853 if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_RIGHT
)
8854 x
= (rect
.x
+ rect
.width
) - tw
- margin
;
8855 else if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_CENTRE
)
8856 x
= x
+ (rect
.width
)/2 - tw
/2;
8858 dc
.DrawText(text
, x
, y
);
8866 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::DrawBitmapBullet(wxRichTextParagraph
* WXUNUSED(paragraph
), wxDC
& WXUNUSED(dc
), const wxRichTextAttr
& WXUNUSED(attr
), const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(rect
))
8868 // Currently unimplemented. The intention is to store bitmaps by name in a media store associated
8869 // with the buffer. The store will allow retrieval from memory, disk or other means.
8873 /// Enumerate the standard bullet names currently supported
8874 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::EnumerateStandardBulletNames(wxArrayString
& bulletNames
)
8876 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/circle"));
8877 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/circle-outline"));
8878 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/square"));
8879 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/diamond"));
8880 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/triangle"));
8889 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextBox
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
)
8891 wxRichTextBox::wxRichTextBox(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
8892 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox(parent
)
8897 bool wxRichTextBox::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
8902 // TODO: if the active object in the control, draw an indication.
8903 // We need to add the concept of active object, and not just focus object,
8904 // so we can apply commands (properties, delete, ...) to objects such as text boxes and images.
8905 // Ultimately we would like to be able to interactively resize an active object
8906 // using drag handles.
8907 return wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Draw(dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
8911 void wxRichTextBox::Copy(const wxRichTextBox
& obj
)
8913 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Copy(obj
);
8916 // Edit properties via a GUI
8917 bool wxRichTextBox::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
8919 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
boxDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, _("Box Properties"));
8920 boxDlg
.SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
8922 if (boxDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
)
8924 // By passing wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET, indeterminate attributes set by the user will be set as
8925 // indeterminate in the object.
8926 boxDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
8937 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextField
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
)
8939 wxRichTextField::wxRichTextField(const wxString
& fieldType
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
8940 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox(parent
)
8942 SetFieldType(fieldType
);
8946 bool wxRichTextField::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
8951 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
8952 if (fieldType
&& fieldType
->Draw(this, dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
))
8955 // Fallback; but don't draw guidelines.
8956 style
&= ~wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_GUIDELINES
;
8957 return wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Draw(dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
8960 bool wxRichTextField::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxRect
& parentRect
, int style
)
8962 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
8963 if (fieldType
&& fieldType
->Layout(this, dc
, context
, rect
, parentRect
, style
))
8967 return wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Layout(dc
, context
, rect
, parentRect
, style
);
8970 bool wxRichTextField::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int flags
, const wxPoint
& position
, const wxSize
& parentSize
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
8972 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
8974 return fieldType
->GetRangeSize((wxRichTextField
*) this, range
, size
, descent
, dc
, context
, flags
, position
, parentSize
, partialExtents
);
8976 return wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetRangeSize(range
, size
, descent
, dc
, context
, flags
, position
, parentSize
, partialExtents
);
8980 void wxRichTextField::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
8983 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::CalculateRange(start
, end
);
8985 wxRichTextObject::CalculateRange(start
, end
);
8989 void wxRichTextField::Copy(const wxRichTextField
& obj
)
8991 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Copy(obj
);
8993 UpdateField(GetBuffer());
8996 // Edit properties via a GUI
8997 bool wxRichTextField::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
8999 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
9001 return fieldType
->EditProperties(this, parent
, buffer
);
9006 bool wxRichTextField::CanEditProperties() const
9008 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
9010 return fieldType
->CanEditProperties((wxRichTextField
*) this);
9015 wxString
wxRichTextField::GetPropertiesMenuLabel() const
9017 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
9019 return fieldType
->GetPropertiesMenuLabel((wxRichTextField
*) this);
9021 return wxEmptyString
;
9024 bool wxRichTextField::UpdateField(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
9026 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
9028 return fieldType
->UpdateField(buffer
, (wxRichTextField
*) this);
9033 bool wxRichTextField::IsTopLevel() const
9035 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(GetFieldType());
9037 return fieldType
->IsTopLevel((wxRichTextField
*) this);
9042 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextFieldType
, wxObject
)
9044 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard
, wxRichTextFieldType
)
9046 wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard(const wxString
& name
, const wxString
& label
, int displayStyle
)
9052 SetDisplayStyle(displayStyle
);
9055 wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard(const wxString
& name
, const wxBitmap
& bitmap
, int displayStyle
)
9061 SetDisplayStyle(displayStyle
);
9064 void wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::Init()
9066 m_displayStyle
= wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_RECTANGLE
;
9067 m_font
= wxFont(6, wxFONTFAMILY_SWISS
, wxFONTSTYLE_NORMAL
, wxFONTWEIGHT_NORMAL
);
9068 m_textColour
= *wxWHITE
;
9069 m_borderColour
= *wxBLACK
;
9070 m_backgroundColour
= *wxBLACK
;
9071 m_verticalPadding
= 1;
9072 m_horizontalPadding
= 3;
9073 m_horizontalMargin
= 2;
9074 m_verticalMargin
= 0;
9077 void wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::Copy(const wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard
& field
)
9079 wxRichTextFieldType::Copy(field
);
9081 m_label
= field
.m_label
;
9082 m_displayStyle
= field
.m_displayStyle
;
9083 m_font
= field
.m_font
;
9084 m_textColour
= field
.m_textColour
;
9085 m_borderColour
= field
.m_borderColour
;
9086 m_backgroundColour
= field
.m_backgroundColour
;
9087 m_verticalPadding
= field
.m_verticalPadding
;
9088 m_horizontalPadding
= field
.m_horizontalPadding
;
9089 m_horizontalMargin
= field
.m_horizontalMargin
;
9090 m_bitmap
= field
.m_bitmap
;
9093 bool wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::Draw(wxRichTextField
* obj
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& WXUNUSED(context
), const wxRichTextRange
& WXUNUSED(range
), const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int WXUNUSED(style
))
9095 if (m_displayStyle
== wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_COMPOSITE
)
9096 return false; // USe default composite drawing
9097 else // if (m_displayStyle == wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_RECTANGLE || m_displayStyle == wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_NOBORDER)
9101 wxPen
borderPen(m_borderColour
, 1, wxSOLID
);
9102 wxBrush
backgroundBrush(m_backgroundColour
);
9103 wxColour
textColour(m_textColour
);
9105 if (selection
.WithinSelection(obj
->GetRange().GetStart(), obj
))
9107 wxColour
highlightColour(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT
));
9108 wxColour
highlightTextColour(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT
));
9110 borderPen
= wxPen(highlightTextColour
, 1, wxSOLID
);
9111 backgroundBrush
= wxBrush(highlightColour
);
9113 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, backgroundBrush
);
9114 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(highlightColour
, 1, wxSOLID
));
9115 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
);
9118 if (m_displayStyle
!= wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_NO_BORDER
)
9121 // objectRect is the area where the content is drawn, after margins around it have been taken into account
9122 wxRect objectRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(rect
.x
+ m_horizontalMargin
, rect
.y
+ wxMax(0, rect
.height
- descent
- obj
->GetCachedSize().y
)),
9123 wxSize(obj
->GetCachedSize().x
- 2*m_horizontalMargin
- borderSize
, obj
->GetCachedSize().y
));
9125 // clientArea is where the text is actually written
9126 wxRect clientArea
= objectRect
;
9128 if (m_displayStyle
== wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_RECTANGLE
)
9130 dc
.SetPen(borderPen
);
9131 dc
.SetBrush(backgroundBrush
);
9132 dc
.DrawRoundedRectangle(objectRect
, 4.0);
9134 else if (m_displayStyle
== wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_START_TAG
)
9136 int arrowLength
= objectRect
.height
/2;
9137 clientArea
.width
-= (arrowLength
- m_horizontalPadding
);
9140 pts
[0].x
= objectRect
.x
; pts
[0].y
= objectRect
.y
;
9141 pts
[1].x
= objectRect
.x
+ objectRect
.width
- arrowLength
; pts
[1].y
= objectRect
.y
;
9142 pts
[2].x
= objectRect
.x
+ objectRect
.width
; pts
[2].y
= objectRect
.y
+ (objectRect
.height
/2);
9143 pts
[3].x
= objectRect
.x
+ objectRect
.width
- arrowLength
; pts
[3].y
= objectRect
.y
+ objectRect
.height
;
9144 pts
[4].x
= objectRect
.x
; pts
[4].y
= objectRect
.y
+ objectRect
.height
;
9145 dc
.SetPen(borderPen
);
9146 dc
.SetBrush(backgroundBrush
);
9147 dc
.DrawPolygon(5, pts
);
9149 else if (m_displayStyle
== wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_END_TAG
)
9151 int arrowLength
= objectRect
.height
/2;
9152 clientArea
.width
-= (arrowLength
- m_horizontalPadding
);
9153 clientArea
.x
+= (arrowLength
- m_horizontalPadding
);
9156 pts
[0].x
= objectRect
.x
+ objectRect
.width
; pts
[0].y
= objectRect
.y
;
9157 pts
[1].x
= objectRect
.x
+ arrowLength
; pts
[1].y
= objectRect
.y
;
9158 pts
[2].x
= objectRect
.x
; pts
[2].y
= objectRect
.y
+ (objectRect
.height
/2);
9159 pts
[3].x
= objectRect
.x
+ arrowLength
; pts
[3].y
= objectRect
.y
+ objectRect
.height
;
9160 pts
[4].x
= objectRect
.x
+ objectRect
.width
; pts
[4].y
= objectRect
.y
+ objectRect
.height
;
9161 dc
.SetPen(borderPen
);
9162 dc
.SetBrush(backgroundBrush
);
9163 dc
.DrawPolygon(5, pts
);
9166 if (m_bitmap
.IsOk())
9168 int x
= clientArea
.x
+ (clientArea
.width
- m_bitmap
.GetWidth())/2;
9169 int y
= clientArea
.y
+ m_verticalPadding
;
9170 dc
.DrawBitmap(m_bitmap
, x
, y
, true);
9172 if (selection
.WithinSelection(obj
->GetRange().GetStart(), obj
))
9174 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, *wxBLACK_BRUSH
);
9175 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, *wxBLACK_PEN
);
9176 dc
.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT
);
9177 dc
.DrawRectangle(wxRect(x
, y
, m_bitmap
.GetWidth(), m_bitmap
.GetHeight()));
9178 dc
.SetLogicalFunction(wxCOPY
);
9183 wxString
label(m_label
);
9184 if (label
.IsEmpty())
9186 int w
, h
, maxDescent
;
9188 dc
.GetTextExtent(m_label
, & w
, &h
, & maxDescent
);
9189 dc
.SetTextForeground(textColour
);
9191 int x
= clientArea
.x
+ (clientArea
.width
- w
)/2;
9192 int y
= clientArea
.y
+ (clientArea
.height
- (h
- maxDescent
))/2;
9193 dc
.DrawText(m_label
, x
, y
);
9200 bool wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::Layout(wxRichTextField
* obj
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(rect
), const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(parentRect
), int style
)
9202 if (m_displayStyle
== wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_COMPOSITE
)
9203 return false; // USe default composite layout
9205 wxSize size
= GetSize(obj
, dc
, context
, style
);
9206 obj
->SetCachedSize(size
);
9207 obj
->SetMinSize(size
);
9208 obj
->SetMaxSize(size
);
9212 bool wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::GetRangeSize(wxRichTextField
* obj
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int flags
, const wxPoint
& position
, const wxSize
& parentSize
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
9214 if (IsTopLevel(obj
))
9215 return obj
->wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetRangeSize(range
, size
, descent
, dc
, context
, flags
, position
, parentSize
);
9218 wxSize sz
= GetSize(obj
, dc
, context
, 0);
9222 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
9223 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
9226 partialExtents
->Add(lastSize
+ sz
.x
);
9233 wxSize
wxRichTextFieldTypeStandard::GetSize(wxRichTextField
* WXUNUSED(obj
), wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& WXUNUSED(context
), int WXUNUSED(style
)) const
9236 int w
= 0, h
= 0, maxDescent
= 0;
9239 if (m_bitmap
.IsOk())
9241 w
= m_bitmap
.GetWidth();
9242 h
= m_bitmap
.GetHeight();
9244 sz
= wxSize(w
+ m_horizontalMargin
*2, h
+ m_verticalMargin
*2);
9248 wxString
label(m_label
);
9249 if (label
.IsEmpty())
9252 dc
.GetTextExtent(label
, & w
, &h
, & maxDescent
);
9254 sz
= wxSize(w
+ m_horizontalPadding
*2 + m_horizontalMargin
*2, h
+ m_verticalPadding
*2 + m_verticalMargin
*2);
9257 if (m_displayStyle
!= wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_NO_BORDER
)
9259 sz
.x
+= borderSize
*2;
9260 sz
.y
+= borderSize
*2;
9263 if (m_displayStyle
== wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_START_TAG
|| m_displayStyle
== wxRICHTEXT_FIELD_STYLE_END_TAG
)
9265 // Add space for the arrow
9266 sz
.x
+= (sz
.y
/2 - m_horizontalPadding
);
9272 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextCell
, wxRichTextBox
)
9274 wxRichTextCell::wxRichTextCell(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
9275 wxRichTextBox(parent
)
9280 bool wxRichTextCell::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
9282 return wxRichTextBox::Draw(dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
9285 int wxRichTextCell::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
9287 int ret
= wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
9288 if (ret
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
9294 textPosition
= m_ownRange
.GetEnd()-1;
9297 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
|wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_OUTSIDE
;
9302 void wxRichTextCell::Copy(const wxRichTextCell
& obj
)
9304 wxRichTextBox::Copy(obj
);
9307 // Edit properties via a GUI
9308 bool wxRichTextCell::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
9310 // We need to gather common attributes for all selected cells.
9312 wxRichTextTable
* table
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextTable
);
9313 bool multipleCells
= false;
9314 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
9316 if (table
&& buffer
&& buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() && buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection().IsValid() &&
9317 buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection().GetContainer() == GetParent())
9319 wxRichTextAttr clashingAttr
, absentAttr
;
9320 const wxRichTextSelection
& sel
= buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection();
9322 int selectedCellCount
= 0;
9323 for (i
= 0; i
< sel
.GetCount(); i
++)
9325 const wxRichTextRange
& range
= sel
[i
];
9326 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= table
->GetCell(range
.GetStart());
9329 wxRichTextAttr cellStyle
= cell
->GetAttributes();
9331 CollectStyle(attr
, cellStyle
, clashingAttr
, absentAttr
);
9333 selectedCellCount
++;
9336 multipleCells
= selectedCellCount
> 1;
9340 attr
= GetAttributes();
9345 caption
= _("Multiple Cell Properties");
9347 caption
= _("Cell Properties");
9349 // We don't want position and floating controls for a cell.
9350 wxRichTextSizePage::ShowPositionControls(false);
9351 wxRichTextSizePage::ShowFloatingControls(false);
9352 wxRichTextSizePage::ShowAlignmentControls(true);
9354 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
cellDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, caption
);
9355 cellDlg
.SetAttributes(attr
);
9357 bool ok
= (cellDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
);
9359 wxRichTextSizePage::ShowPositionControls(true);
9360 wxRichTextSizePage::ShowFloatingControls(true);
9366 const wxRichTextSelection
& sel
= buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection();
9367 // Apply the style; we interpret indeterminate attributes as 'don't touch this attribute'
9368 // since it may represent clashing attributes across multiple objects.
9369 table
->SetCellStyle(sel
, attr
);
9372 // For a single object, indeterminate attributes set by the user should be reflected in the
9373 // actual object style, so pass the wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET flag to assign
9374 // the style directly instead of applying (which ignores indeterminate attributes,
9375 // leaving them as they were).
9376 cellDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
9383 // The next 2 methods return span values. Note that the default is 1, not 0
9384 int wxRichTextCell::GetColspan() const
9387 if (GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("colspan")))
9389 span
= GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("colspan"));
9395 int wxRichTextCell::GetRowspan() const
9398 if (GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("rowspan")))
9400 span
= GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("rowspan"));
9406 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextObjectPtrArrayArray
)
9408 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextTable
, wxRichTextBox
)
9410 wxRichTextTable::wxRichTextTable(wxRichTextObject
* parent
): wxRichTextBox(parent
)
9416 // Draws the object.
9417 bool wxRichTextTable::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
9419 wxRichTextBox::Draw(dc
, context
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
9421 int colCount
= GetColumnCount();
9422 int rowCount
= GetRowCount();
9424 for (col
= 0; col
< colCount
; col
++)
9426 for (row
= 0; row
< rowCount
; row
++)
9428 if (row
== 0 || row
== (rowCount
-1) || col
== 0 || col
== (colCount
-1))
9430 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(row
, col
);
9431 if (cell
&& cell
->IsShown() && !cell
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
9433 wxRect
childRect(cell
->GetPosition(), cell
->GetCachedSize());
9434 wxRichTextAttr
attr(cell
->GetAttributes());
9436 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetTop().Reset();
9437 if (row
!= (rowCount
-1))
9438 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetBottom().Reset();
9440 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetLeft().Reset();
9441 if (col
!= (colCount
-1))
9442 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetRight().Reset();
9444 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().IsValid())
9446 wxRect
boxRect(cell
->GetPosition(), cell
->GetCachedSize());
9447 wxRect marginRect
= boxRect
;
9448 wxRect contentRect
, borderRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
9450 cell
->GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
9451 cell
->DrawBorder(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder(), borderRect
);
9461 // Helper function for Layout() that clears the space needed by a cell with rowspan > 1
9462 int GetRowspanDisplacement(const wxRichTextTable
* table
, int row
, int col
, int paddingX
, const wxArrayInt
& colWidths
)
9464 // If one or more cells above-left of this one has rowspan > 1, the affected cells below it
9465 // will have been hidden and have width 0. As a result they are ignored by the layout algorithm,
9466 // and all cells to their right are effectively shifted left. As a result there's no hole for
9467 // the spanning cell to fill.
9468 // So search back along the current row for hidden cells. However there's also the annoying issue of a
9469 // rowspanning cell that also has colspam. So we can't rely on the rowspanning cell being directly above
9470 // the first hidden one we come to. We also can't rely on a cell being hidden only by one type of span;
9471 // there's nothing to stop a cell being hidden by colspan, and then again hidden from above by rowspan.
9472 // The answer is to look above each hidden cell in turn, which I think covers all bases.
9474 for (int prevcol
= 0; prevcol
< col
; ++prevcol
)
9476 if (!table
->GetCell(row
, prevcol
)->IsShown())
9478 // We've found a hidden cell. If it's hidden because of colspan to its left, it's
9479 // already been taken into account; but not if there's a rowspanning cell above
9480 for (int prevrow
= row
-1; prevrow
>= 0; --prevrow
)
9482 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= table
->GetCell(prevrow
, prevcol
);
9483 if (cell
&& cell
->IsShown())
9485 int rowSpan
= cell
->GetRowspan();
9486 if (rowSpan
> 1 && rowSpan
> (row
-prevrow
))
9488 // There is a rowspanning cell above above the hidden one, so we need
9489 // to right-shift the index cell by this column's width. Furthermore,
9490 // if the cell also colspans, we need to shift by all affected columns
9491 for (int colSpan
= 0; colSpan
< cell
->GetColspan(); ++colSpan
)
9492 deltaX
+= (colWidths
[prevcol
+colSpan
] + paddingX
);
9502 // Helper function for Layout() that expands any cell with rowspan > 1
9503 void ExpandCellsWithRowspan(const wxRichTextTable
* table
, int paddingY
, int& bottomY
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& availableSpace
, int style
)
9505 // This is called when the table's cell layout is otherwise complete.
9506 // For any cell with rowspan > 1, expand downwards into the row(s) below.
9508 // Start by finding the current 'y' of the top of each row, plus the bottom of the available area for cells.
9509 // Deduce this from the top of a visible cell in the row below. (If none are visible, the row will be invisible anyway and can be ignored.)
9510 const int rowCount
= table
->GetRowCount();
9511 const int colCount
= table
->GetColumnCount();
9513 rowTops
.Add(0, rowCount
+1);
9515 for (row
= 0; row
< rowCount
; ++row
)
9517 for (int column
= 0; column
< colCount
; ++column
)
9519 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= table
->GetCell(row
, column
);
9520 if (cell
&& cell
->IsShown())
9522 rowTops
[row
] = cell
->GetPosition().y
;
9527 rowTops
[rowCount
] = bottomY
+ paddingY
; // The table bottom, which was passed to us
9529 bool needsRelay
= false;
9531 for (row
= 0; row
< rowCount
-1; ++row
) // -1 as the bottom row can't rowspan
9533 for (int col
= 0; col
< colCount
; ++col
)
9535 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= table
->GetCell(row
, col
);
9536 if (cell
&& cell
->IsShown())
9538 int span
= cell
->GetRowspan();
9541 span
= wxMin(span
, rowCount
-row
); // Don't try to span below the table!
9545 int availableHeight
= rowTops
[row
+span
] - rowTops
[row
] - paddingY
;
9546 wxSize newSize
= wxSize(cell
->GetCachedSize().GetWidth(), availableHeight
);
9547 wxRect availableCellSpace
= wxRect(cell
->GetPosition(), newSize
);
9548 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
9549 cell
->Layout(dc
, context
, availableCellSpace
, availableSpace
, style
);
9550 // Ensure there's room in the span to display its contents, else it'll overwrite lower rows
9551 int overhang
= cell
->GetCachedSize().GetHeight() - availableHeight
;
9552 cell
->SetCachedSize(newSize
);
9556 // There are 3 things to get right:
9557 // 1) The easiest is the rows below the span: they need to be downshifted by the overhang, and so does the table bottom itself
9558 // 2) The rows within the span, including the one holding this cell, need to be deepened by their share of the overhang
9559 // e.g. if rowspan == 3, each row should increase in depth by 1/3rd of the overhang.
9560 // 3) The cell with the rowspan shouldn't be touched in 2); its height will be set to the whole span later.
9561 int deltaY
= overhang
/ span
;
9562 int spare
= overhang
% span
;
9564 // Each row in the span needs to by deepened by its share of the overhang (give the first row any spare).
9565 // This is achieved by increasing the value stored in the following row's rowTops
9566 for (int spannedRows
= 0; spannedRows
< span
; ++spannedRows
)
9568 rowTops
[row
+spannedRows
+1] += ((deltaY
* (spannedRows
+1)) + (spannedRows
== 0 ? spare
:0));
9571 // Any rows below the span need shifting down
9572 for (int rowsBelow
= row
+ span
+1; rowsBelow
<= rowCount
; ++rowsBelow
)
9574 rowTops
[rowsBelow
] += overhang
;
9587 // There were overflowing rowspanning cells, so layout yet again to make the increased row depths show
9588 for (row
= 0; row
< rowCount
; ++row
)
9590 for (int col
= 0; col
< colCount
; ++col
)
9592 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= table
->GetCell(row
, col
);
9593 if (cell
&& cell
->IsShown())
9595 wxPoint
position(cell
->GetPosition().x
, rowTops
[row
]);
9597 // GetRowspan() will usually return 1, but may be greater
9598 wxSize
size(cell
->GetCachedSize().GetWidth(), rowTops
[row
+ cell
->GetRowspan()] - rowTops
[row
] - paddingY
);
9600 wxRect availableCellSpace
= wxRect(position
, size
);
9601 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
9602 cell
->Layout(dc
, context
, availableCellSpace
, availableSpace
, style
);
9603 cell
->SetCachedSize(size
);
9607 bottomY
= rowTops
[rowCount
] - paddingY
;
9611 // Lays the object out. rect is the space available for layout. Often it will
9612 // be the specified overall space for this object, if trying to constrain
9613 // layout to a particular size, or it could be the total space available in the
9614 // parent. rect is the overall size, so we must subtract margins and padding.
9615 // to get the actual available space.
9616 bool wxRichTextTable::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(parentRect
), int style
)
9618 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
9620 // The meaty bit. Calculate sizes of all cells and rows. Try to use
9621 // minimum size if within alloted size, then divide up remaining size
9622 // between rows/cols.
9625 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
9626 if (buffer
) scale
= buffer
->GetScale();
9628 wxRect availableSpace
= GetAvailableContentArea(dc
, context
, rect
);
9629 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, availableSpace
.GetSize());
9631 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetAttributes());
9632 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, this);
9634 bool tableHasPercentWidth
= (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
);
9635 // If we have no fixed table size, and assuming we're not pushed for
9636 // space, then we don't have to try to stretch the table to fit the contents.
9637 bool stretchToFitTableWidth
= tableHasPercentWidth
;
9639 int tableWidth
= rect
.width
;
9640 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid() && !tableHasPercentWidth
)
9642 tableWidth
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
9644 // Fixed table width, so we do want to stretch columns out if necessary.
9645 stretchToFitTableWidth
= true;
9647 // Shouldn't be able to exceed the size passed to this function
9648 tableWidth
= wxMin(rect
.width
, tableWidth
);
9651 // Get internal padding
9652 int paddingLeft
= 0, paddingTop
= 0;
9653 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft().IsValid())
9654 paddingLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft());
9655 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop().IsValid())
9656 paddingTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop());
9658 // Assume that left and top padding are also used for inter-cell padding.
9659 int paddingX
= paddingLeft
;
9660 int paddingY
= paddingTop
;
9662 int totalLeftMargin
= 0, totalRightMargin
= 0, totalTopMargin
= 0, totalBottomMargin
= 0;
9663 GetTotalMargin(dc
, buffer
, attr
, totalLeftMargin
, totalRightMargin
, totalTopMargin
, totalBottomMargin
);
9665 // Internal table width - the area for content
9666 int internalTableWidth
= tableWidth
- totalLeftMargin
- totalRightMargin
;
9668 int rowCount
= m_cells
.GetCount();
9669 if (m_colCount
== 0 || rowCount
== 0)
9671 wxRect
overallRect(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, totalLeftMargin
+ totalRightMargin
, totalTopMargin
+ totalBottomMargin
);
9672 SetCachedSize(overallRect
.GetSize());
9674 // Zero content size
9675 SetMinSize(overallRect
.GetSize());
9676 SetMaxSize(GetMinSize());
9680 // The final calculated widths
9681 wxArrayInt colWidths
;
9682 colWidths
.Add(0, m_colCount
);
9684 wxArrayInt absoluteColWidths
;
9685 absoluteColWidths
.Add(0, m_colCount
);
9687 wxArrayInt percentageColWidths
;
9688 percentageColWidths
.Add(0, m_colCount
);
9690 // The required width of a column calculated from the content, in case we don't specify any widths
9691 wxArrayInt maxUnspecifiedColumnWidths
;
9692 maxUnspecifiedColumnWidths
.Add(0, m_colCount
);
9694 // wxArrayInt percentageColWidthsSpanning(m_colCount);
9695 // These are only relevant when the first column contains spanning information.
9696 // wxArrayInt columnSpans(m_colCount); // Each contains 1 for non-spanning cell, > 1 for spanning cell.
9697 wxArrayInt maxColWidths
;
9698 maxColWidths
.Add(0, m_colCount
);
9699 wxArrayInt minColWidths
;
9700 minColWidths
.Add(0, m_colCount
);
9702 wxSize
tableSize(tableWidth
, 0);
9706 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9708 absoluteColWidths
[i
] = 0;
9709 // absoluteColWidthsSpanning[i] = 0;
9710 percentageColWidths
[i
] = -1;
9711 // percentageColWidthsSpanning[i] = -1;
9713 maxColWidths
[i
] = 0;
9714 minColWidths
[i
] = 0;
9715 // columnSpans[i] = 1;
9718 // (0) Determine which cells are visible according to spans
9720 // __________________
9725 // |------------------|
9726 // |__________________| 4
9728 // To calculate cell visibility:
9729 // First find all spanning cells. Build an array of span records with start x, y and end x, y.
9730 // Then for each cell, test whether we're within one of those cells, and unless we're at the start of
9731 // that cell, hide the cell.
9733 // We can also use this array to match the size of spanning cells to the grid. Or just do
9734 // this when we iterate through all cells.
9736 // 0.1: add spanning cells to an array
9737 wxRichTextRectArray rectArray
;
9738 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
9740 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9742 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
9743 int colSpan
= cell
->GetColspan();
9744 int rowSpan
= cell
->GetRowspan();
9745 if (colSpan
> 1 || rowSpan
> 1)
9747 rectArray
.Add(wxRect(i
, j
, colSpan
, rowSpan
));
9751 // 0.2: find which cells are subsumed by a spanning cell
9752 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
9754 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9756 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
9757 if (rectArray
.GetCount() == 0)
9763 int colSpan
= cell
->GetColspan();
9764 int rowSpan
= cell
->GetRowspan();
9766 if (colSpan
> 1 || rowSpan
> 1)
9768 // Assume all spanning cells are shown
9774 for (k
= 0; k
< (int) rectArray
.GetCount(); k
++)
9776 if (rectArray
[k
].Contains(wxPoint(i
, j
)))
9788 // Find the first spanned cell in each row that spans the most columns and doesn't
9789 // overlap with a spanned cell starting at a previous column position.
9790 // This means we need to keep an array of rects so we can check. However
9791 // it does also mean that some spans simply may not be taken into account
9792 // where there are different spans happening on different rows. In these cases,
9793 // they will simply be as wide as their constituent columns.
9795 // (1) Do an initial layout for all cells to get minimum and maximum size, and get
9796 // the absolute or percentage width of each column.
9798 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
9800 // First get the overall margins so we can calculate percentage widths based on
9801 // the available content space for all cells on the row
9803 int overallRowContentMargin
= 0;
9804 int visibleCellCount
= 0;
9806 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9808 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
9809 if (cell
->IsShown())
9811 int cellTotalLeftMargin
= 0, cellTotalRightMargin
= 0, cellTotalTopMargin
= 0, cellTotalBottomMargin
= 0;
9812 GetTotalMargin(dc
, buffer
, cell
->GetAttributes(), cellTotalLeftMargin
, cellTotalRightMargin
, cellTotalTopMargin
, cellTotalBottomMargin
);
9814 overallRowContentMargin
+= (cellTotalLeftMargin
+ cellTotalRightMargin
);
9815 visibleCellCount
++;
9819 // Add in inter-cell padding
9820 overallRowContentMargin
+= ((visibleCellCount
-1) * paddingX
);
9822 int rowContentWidth
= internalTableWidth
- overallRowContentMargin
;
9823 wxSize
rowTableSize(rowContentWidth
, 0);
9824 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, rowTableSize
);
9826 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9828 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
9829 if (cell
->IsShown())
9831 int colSpan
= cell
->GetColspan();
9833 // Lay out cell to find min/max widths
9834 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
9835 cell
->Layout(dc
, context
, availableSpace
, availableSpace
, style
);
9839 int absoluteCellWidth
= -1;
9840 int percentageCellWidth
= -1;
9842 // I think we need to calculate percentages from the internal table size,
9843 // minus the padding between cells which we'll need to calculate from the
9844 // (number of VISIBLE cells - 1)*paddingX. Then percentages that add up to 100%
9845 // will add up to 100%. In CSS, the width specifies the cell's content rect width,
9846 // so if we want to conform to that we'll need to add in the overall cell margins.
9847 // However, this will make it difficult to specify percentages that add up to
9848 // 100% and still fit within the table width.
9849 // Let's say two cells have 50% width. They have 10 pixels of overall margin each.
9850 // The table content rect is 500 pixels and the inter-cell padding is 20 pixels.
9851 // If we're using internal content size for the width, we would calculate the
9852 // the overall cell width for n cells as:
9853 // (500 - 20*(n-1) - overallCellMargin1 - overallCellMargin2 - ...) * percentage / 100
9854 // + thisOverallCellMargin
9855 // = 500 - 20 - 10 - 10) * 0.5 + 10 = 240 pixels overall cell width.
9856 // Adding this back, we get 240 + 240 + 20 = 500 pixels.
9858 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid())
9860 int w
= converter
.GetPixels(cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
9861 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
9863 percentageCellWidth
= w
;
9867 absoluteCellWidth
= w
;
9869 // Override absolute width with minimum width if necessary
9870 if (cell
->GetMinSize().x
> 0 && absoluteCellWidth
!=1 && cell
->GetMinSize().x
> absoluteCellWidth
)
9871 absoluteCellWidth
= cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
9874 maxUnspecifiedColumnWidths
[i
] = wxMax(cell
->GetMaxSize().x
, maxUnspecifiedColumnWidths
[i
]);
9876 if (absoluteCellWidth
!= -1)
9878 if (absoluteCellWidth
> absoluteColWidths
[i
])
9879 absoluteColWidths
[i
] = absoluteCellWidth
;
9882 if (percentageCellWidth
!= -1)
9884 if (percentageCellWidth
> percentageColWidths
[i
])
9885 percentageColWidths
[i
] = percentageCellWidth
;
9888 if (colSpan
== 1 && cell
->GetMinSize().x
&& cell
->GetMinSize().x
> minColWidths
[i
])
9889 minColWidths
[i
] = cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
9890 if (colSpan
== 1 && cell
->GetMaxSize().x
&& cell
->GetMaxSize().x
> maxColWidths
[i
])
9891 maxColWidths
[i
] = cell
->GetMaxSize().x
;
9897 // (2) Allocate initial column widths from minimum widths, absolute values and proportions
9898 // TODO: simply merge this into (1).
9899 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9901 if (absoluteColWidths
[i
] > 0)
9903 colWidths
[i
] = absoluteColWidths
[i
];
9905 else if (percentageColWidths
[i
] > 0)
9907 colWidths
[i
] = percentageColWidths
[i
];
9909 // This is rubbish - we calculated the absolute widths from percentages, so
9910 // we can't do it again here.
9911 //colWidths[i] = (int) (double(percentageColWidths[i]) * double(tableWidth) / 100.0 + 0.5);
9915 // (3) Process absolute or proportional widths of spanning columns,
9916 // now that we know what our fixed column widths are going to be.
9917 // Spanned cells will try to adjust columns so the span will fit.
9918 // Even existing fixed column widths can be expanded if necessary.
9919 // Actually, currently fixed columns widths aren't adjusted; instead,
9920 // the algorithm favours earlier rows and adjusts unspecified column widths
9921 // the first time only. After that, we can't know whether the column has been
9922 // specified explicitly or not. (We could make a note if necessary.)
9923 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
9925 // First get the overall margins so we can calculate percentage widths based on
9926 // the available content space for all cells on the row
9928 int overallRowContentMargin
= 0;
9929 int visibleCellCount
= 0;
9931 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9933 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
9934 if (cell
->IsShown())
9936 int cellTotalLeftMargin
= 0, cellTotalRightMargin
= 0, cellTotalTopMargin
= 0, cellTotalBottomMargin
= 0;
9937 GetTotalMargin(dc
, buffer
, cell
->GetAttributes(), cellTotalLeftMargin
, cellTotalRightMargin
, cellTotalTopMargin
, cellTotalBottomMargin
);
9939 overallRowContentMargin
+= (cellTotalLeftMargin
+ cellTotalRightMargin
);
9940 visibleCellCount
++;
9944 // Add in inter-cell padding
9945 overallRowContentMargin
+= ((visibleCellCount
-1) * paddingX
);
9947 int rowContentWidth
= internalTableWidth
- overallRowContentMargin
;
9948 wxSize
rowTableSize(rowContentWidth
, 0);
9949 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, rowTableSize
);
9951 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
9953 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
9954 if (cell
->IsShown())
9956 int colSpan
= cell
->GetColspan();
9959 int spans
= wxMin(colSpan
, m_colCount
- i
);
9963 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid())
9965 cellWidth
= converter
.GetPixels(cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
9966 // Override absolute width with minimum width if necessary
9967 if (cell
->GetMinSize().x
> 0 && cellWidth
!=1 && cell
->GetMinSize().x
> cellWidth
)
9968 cellWidth
= cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
9972 // Do we want to do this? It's the only chance we get to
9973 // use the cell's min/max sizes, so we need to work out
9974 // how we're going to balance the unspecified spanning cell
9975 // width with the possibility more-constrained constituent cell widths.
9976 // Say there's a tiny bitmap giving it a max width of 10 pixels. We
9977 // don't want to constraint all the spanned columns to fit into this cell.
9978 // OK, let's say that if any of the constituent columns don't fit,
9979 // then we simply stop constraining the columns; instead, we'll just fit the spanning
9980 // cells to the columns later.
9981 cellWidth
= cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
9983 maxUnspecifiedColumnWidths
[i
] = wxMax(cell
->GetMaxSize().x
, maxUnspecifiedColumnWidths
[i
]);
9985 if (cell
->GetMaxSize().x
> cellWidth
)
9986 cellWidth
= cell
->GetMaxSize().x
;
9989 // Subtract the padding between cells
9990 int spanningWidth
= cellWidth
;
9991 spanningWidth
-= paddingX
* (spans
-1);
9993 if (spanningWidth
> 0)
9995 // Now share the spanning width between columns within that span
9996 // TODO: take into account min widths of columns within the span
9997 int spanningWidthLeft
= spanningWidth
;
9998 int stretchColCount
= 0;
9999 for (k
= i
; k
< (i
+spans
); k
++)
10001 if (colWidths
[k
] > 0) // absolute or proportional width has been specified
10002 spanningWidthLeft
-= colWidths
[k
];
10004 stretchColCount
++;
10006 // Now divide what's left between the remaining columns
10008 if (stretchColCount
> 0)
10009 colShare
= spanningWidthLeft
/ stretchColCount
;
10010 int colShareRemainder
= spanningWidthLeft
- (colShare
* stretchColCount
);
10012 // If fixed-width columns are currently too big, then we'll later
10013 // stretch the spanned cell to fit.
10015 if (spanningWidthLeft
> 0)
10017 for (k
= i
; k
< (i
+spans
); k
++)
10019 if (colWidths
[k
] <= 0) // absolute or proportional width has not been specified
10021 int newWidth
= colShare
;
10022 if (k
== (i
+spans
-1))
10023 newWidth
+= colShareRemainder
; // ensure all pixels are filled
10024 colWidths
[k
] = newWidth
;
10035 // (3.1) if a column has zero width, make it the maximum unspecified width (i.e. using
10036 // the cell's contents to calculate the width)
10037 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
10039 if (colWidths
[i
] == 0)
10040 colWidths
[i
] = maxUnspecifiedColumnWidths
[i
];
10043 // (4) Next, share any remaining space out between columns that have not yet been calculated.
10044 // TODO: take into account min widths of columns within the span
10045 int tableWidthMinusPadding
= internalTableWidth
- (m_colCount
-1)*paddingX
;
10046 int widthLeft
= tableWidthMinusPadding
;
10047 int stretchColCount
= 0;
10048 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
10050 // Subtract min width from width left, then
10051 // add the colShare to the min width
10052 if (colWidths
[i
] > 0) // absolute or proportional width has been specified
10053 widthLeft
-= colWidths
[i
];
10056 if (minColWidths
[i
] > 0)
10057 widthLeft
-= minColWidths
[i
];
10059 stretchColCount
++;
10063 // Now divide what's left between the remaining columns
10065 if (stretchColCount
> 0)
10066 colShare
= widthLeft
/ stretchColCount
;
10067 int colShareRemainder
= widthLeft
- (colShare
* stretchColCount
);
10069 // Check we don't have enough space, in which case shrink all columns, overriding
10070 // any absolute/proportional widths
10071 // TODO: actually we would like to divide up the shrinkage according to size.
10072 // How do we calculate the proportions that will achieve this?
10073 // Could first choose an arbitrary value for stretching cells, and then calculate
10074 // factors to multiply each width by.
10075 // TODO: want to record this fact and pass to an iteration that tries e.g. min widths
10076 if (widthLeft
< 0 || (stretchToFitTableWidth
&& (stretchColCount
== 0)))
10078 colShare
= tableWidthMinusPadding
/ m_colCount
;
10079 colShareRemainder
= tableWidthMinusPadding
- (colShare
* m_colCount
);
10080 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
10083 minColWidths
[i
] = 0;
10087 // We have to adjust the columns if either we need to shrink the
10088 // table to fit the parent/table width, or we explicitly set the
10089 // table width and need to stretch out the table.
10090 if (widthLeft
< 0 || stretchToFitTableWidth
)
10092 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
10094 if (colWidths
[i
] <= 0) // absolute or proportional width has not been specified
10096 if (minColWidths
[i
] > 0)
10097 colWidths
[i
] = minColWidths
[i
] + colShare
;
10099 colWidths
[i
] = colShare
;
10100 if (i
== (m_colCount
-1))
10101 colWidths
[i
] += colShareRemainder
; // ensure all pixels are filled
10107 So, now we've laid out the table to fit into the given space
10108 and have used specified widths and minimum widths.
10110 Now we need to consider how we will try to take maximum width into account.
10114 // (??) TODO: take max width into account
10116 // (6) Lay out all cells again with the current values
10119 int y
= availableSpace
.y
;
10120 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
10122 int x
= availableSpace
.x
; // TODO: take into account centering etc.
10123 int maxCellHeight
= 0;
10124 int maxSpecifiedCellHeight
= 0;
10126 wxArrayInt actualWidths
;
10127 actualWidths
.Add(0, m_colCount
);
10129 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
);
10130 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
10132 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
10133 if (cell
->IsShown())
10135 // Get max specified cell height
10136 // Don't handle percentages for height
10137 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().IsValid() && cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetUnits() != wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
10139 int h
= converter
.GetPixels(cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight());
10140 if (h
> maxSpecifiedCellHeight
)
10141 maxSpecifiedCellHeight
= h
;
10144 if (colWidths
[i
] > 0) // absolute or proportional width has been specified
10146 int colSpan
= cell
->GetColspan();
10147 wxRect availableCellSpace
;
10149 // Take into account spans
10152 // Calculate the size of this spanning cell from its constituent columns
10154 int spans
= wxMin(colSpan
, m_colCount
- i
);
10155 for (k
= i
; k
< (i
+spans
); k
++)
10159 xx
+= colWidths
[k
];
10161 availableCellSpace
= wxRect(x
, y
, xx
, -1);
10164 availableCellSpace
= wxRect(x
, y
, colWidths
[i
], -1);
10166 // Store actual width so we can force cell to be the appropriate width on the final loop
10167 actualWidths
[i
] = availableCellSpace
.GetWidth();
10169 // We now need to shift right by the width of any rowspanning cells above-left of us
10170 int deltaX
= GetRowspanDisplacement(this, j
, i
, paddingX
, colWidths
);
10171 availableCellSpace
.SetX(availableCellSpace
.GetX() + deltaX
);
10174 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
10175 cell
->Layout(dc
, context
, availableCellSpace
, availableSpace
, style
);
10177 // TODO: use GetCachedSize().x to compute 'natural' size
10179 x
+= (availableCellSpace
.GetWidth() + paddingX
);
10180 if ((cell
->GetCachedSize().y
> maxCellHeight
) && (cell
->GetRowspan() < 2))
10181 maxCellHeight
= cell
->GetCachedSize().y
;
10186 maxCellHeight
= wxMax(maxCellHeight
, maxSpecifiedCellHeight
);
10188 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
10190 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
10191 if (cell
->IsShown())
10193 wxRect availableCellSpace
= wxRect(cell
->GetPosition(), wxSize(actualWidths
[i
], maxCellHeight
));
10194 // Lay out cell with new height
10195 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
10196 cell
->Layout(dc
, context
, availableCellSpace
, availableSpace
, style
);
10198 // Make sure the cell size really is the appropriate size,
10199 // not the calculated box size
10200 cell
->SetCachedSize(wxSize(actualWidths
[i
], maxCellHeight
));
10202 maxRight
= wxMax(maxRight
, cell
->GetPosition().x
+ cell
->GetCachedSize().x
);
10206 y
+= maxCellHeight
;
10207 if (j
< (m_rowCount
-1))
10211 // Finally we need to expand any cell with rowspan > 1. We couldn't earlier; lower rows' heights weren't known
10212 ExpandCellsWithRowspan(this, paddingY
, y
, dc
, context
, availableSpace
, style
);
10214 // We need to add back the margins etc.
10216 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
10217 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxRight
- availableSpace
.x
, y
- availableSpace
.y
));
10218 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
10219 SetCachedSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
10222 // TODO: calculate max size
10224 SetMaxSize(GetCachedSize());
10227 // TODO: calculate min size
10229 SetMinSize(GetCachedSize());
10235 // Finds the absolute position and row height for the given character position
10236 bool wxRichTextTable::FindPosition(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, long index
, wxPoint
& pt
, int* height
, bool forceLineStart
)
10238 wxRichTextCell
* child
= GetCell(index
+1);
10241 // Find the position at the start of the child cell, since the table doesn't
10242 // have any caret position of its own.
10243 return child
->FindPosition(dc
, context
, -1, pt
, height
, forceLineStart
);
10249 // Get the cell at the given character position (in the range of the table).
10250 wxRichTextCell
* wxRichTextTable::GetCell(long pos
) const
10252 int row
= 0, col
= 0;
10253 if (GetCellRowColumnPosition(pos
, row
, col
))
10255 return GetCell(row
, col
);
10261 // Get the row/column for a given character position
10262 bool wxRichTextTable::GetCellRowColumnPosition(long pos
, int& row
, int& col
) const
10264 if (m_colCount
== 0 || m_rowCount
== 0)
10267 row
= (int) (pos
/ m_colCount
);
10268 col
= pos
- (row
* m_colCount
);
10270 wxASSERT(row
< m_rowCount
&& col
< m_colCount
);
10272 if (row
< m_rowCount
&& col
< m_colCount
)
10278 // Calculate range, taking row/cell ordering into account instead of relying
10279 // on list ordering.
10280 void wxRichTextTable::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
10282 long current
= start
;
10283 long lastEnd
= current
;
10292 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
10294 for (j
= 0; j
< m_colCount
; j
++)
10296 wxRichTextCell
* child
= GetCell(i
, j
);
10301 child
->CalculateRange(current
, childEnd
);
10303 lastEnd
= childEnd
;
10304 current
= childEnd
+ 1;
10309 // A top-level object always has a range of size 1,
10310 // because its children don't count at this level.
10312 m_range
.SetRange(start
, start
);
10314 // An object with no children has zero length
10315 if (m_children
.GetCount() == 0)
10317 m_ownRange
.SetRange(0, lastEnd
);
10320 // Gets the range size.
10321 bool wxRichTextTable::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int flags
, const wxPoint
& position
, const wxSize
& parentSize
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
10323 return wxRichTextBox::GetRangeSize(range
, size
, descent
, dc
, context
, flags
, position
, parentSize
, partialExtents
);
10326 // Deletes content in the given range.
10327 bool wxRichTextTable::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& WXUNUSED(range
))
10329 // TODO: implement deletion of cells
10333 // Gets any text in this object for the given range.
10334 wxString
wxRichTextTable::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
10336 return wxRichTextBox::GetTextForRange(range
);
10339 // Copies this object.
10340 void wxRichTextTable::Copy(const wxRichTextTable
& obj
)
10342 wxRichTextBox::Copy(obj
);
10346 m_rowCount
= obj
.m_rowCount
;
10347 m_colCount
= obj
.m_colCount
;
10349 m_cells
.Add(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray(), m_rowCount
);
10352 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
10354 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[i
];
10355 for (j
= 0; j
< m_colCount
; j
++)
10357 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= wxDynamicCast(obj
.GetCell(i
, j
)->Clone(), wxRichTextCell
);
10360 colArray
.Add(cell
);
10365 void wxRichTextTable::ClearTable()
10373 bool wxRichTextTable::CreateTable(int rows
, int cols
)
10377 wxRichTextAttr cellattr
;
10378 cellattr
.SetTextColour(GetBasicStyle().GetTextColour());
10383 m_cells
.Add(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray(), rows
);
10386 for (i
= 0; i
< rows
; i
++)
10388 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[i
];
10389 for (j
= 0; j
< cols
; j
++)
10391 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= new wxRichTextCell
;
10392 cell
->GetAttributes() = cellattr
;
10395 cell
->AddParagraph(wxEmptyString
);
10397 colArray
.Add(cell
);
10404 wxRichTextCell
* wxRichTextTable::GetCell(int row
, int col
) const
10406 wxASSERT(row
< m_rowCount
);
10407 wxASSERT(col
< m_colCount
);
10409 if (row
< m_rowCount
&& col
< m_colCount
)
10411 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[row
];
10412 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= colArray
[col
];
10413 return wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextCell
);
10419 // Returns a selection object specifying the selections between start and end character positions.
10420 // For example, a table would deduce what cells (of range length 1) are selected when dragging across the table.
10421 wxRichTextSelection
wxRichTextTable::GetSelection(long start
, long end
) const
10423 wxRichTextSelection selection
;
10424 selection
.SetContainer((wxRichTextTable
*) this);
10433 wxASSERT( start
>= 0 && end
< (m_colCount
* m_rowCount
));
10435 if (end
>= (m_colCount
* m_rowCount
))
10438 // We need to find the rectangle of cells that is described by the rectangle
10439 // with start, end as the diagonal. Make sure we don't add cells that are
10440 // not currenty visible because they are overlapped by spanning cells.
10442 --------------------------
10443 | 0 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
10444 --------------------------
10445 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 |
10446 --------------------------
10447 | 10 | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 |
10448 --------------------------
10449 | 15 | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 |
10450 --------------------------
10452 Let's say we select 6 -> 18.
10454 Left and right edge cols of rectangle are 1 and 3 inclusive. Find least/greatest to find
10455 which is left and which is right.
10457 Top and bottom edge rows are 1 and 3 inclusive. Again, find least/greatest to find top and bottom.
10459 Now go through rows from 1 to 3 and only add cells that are (a) within above column range
10465 int leftCol
= start
- m_colCount
* int(start
/m_colCount
);
10466 int rightCol
= end
- m_colCount
* int(end
/m_colCount
);
10468 int topRow
= int(start
/m_colCount
);
10469 int bottomRow
= int(end
/m_colCount
);
10471 if (leftCol
> rightCol
)
10473 int tmp
= rightCol
;
10474 rightCol
= leftCol
;
10478 if (topRow
> bottomRow
)
10480 int tmp
= bottomRow
;
10481 bottomRow
= topRow
;
10486 for (i
= topRow
; i
<= bottomRow
; i
++)
10488 for (j
= leftCol
; j
<= rightCol
; j
++)
10490 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(i
, j
);
10491 if (cell
&& cell
->IsShown())
10492 selection
.Add(cell
->GetRange());
10499 // Sets the attributes for the cells specified by the selection.
10500 bool wxRichTextTable::SetCellStyle(const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, int flags
)
10502 if (selection
.GetContainer() != this)
10505 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
10506 bool haveControl
= (buffer
&& buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
10507 bool withUndo
= haveControl
&& ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
10510 buffer
->BeginBatchUndo(_("Set Cell Style"));
10512 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
10515 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextCell
);
10516 if (cell
&& selection
.WithinSelection(cell
->GetRange().GetStart()))
10517 SetStyle(cell
, style
, flags
);
10518 node
= node
->GetNext();
10521 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
10523 buffer
->EndBatchUndo();
10528 wxPosition
wxRichTextTable::GetFocusedCell() const
10530 wxPosition
position(-1, -1);
10531 const wxRichTextObject
* focus
= GetBuffer()->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetFocusObject();
10533 for (int row
= 0; row
< GetRowCount(); ++row
)
10535 for (int col
= 0; col
< GetColumnCount(); ++col
)
10537 if (GetCell(row
, col
) == focus
)
10539 position
.SetRow(row
);
10540 position
.SetCol(col
);
10549 int wxRichTextTable::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
10551 for (int row
= 0; row
< GetRowCount(); ++row
)
10553 for (int col
= 0; col
< GetColumnCount(); ++col
)
10555 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(row
, col
);
10556 if (cell
->wxRichTextObject::HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
) != wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
10558 return cell
->HitTest(dc
, context
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
10563 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
10566 bool wxRichTextTable::DeleteRows(int startRow
, int noRows
)
10568 wxASSERT((startRow
+ noRows
) <= m_rowCount
);
10569 if ((startRow
+ noRows
) > m_rowCount
)
10572 wxCHECK_MSG(noRows
!= m_rowCount
, false, "Trying to delete all the cells in a table");
10574 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
10575 wxRichTextCtrl
* rtc
= buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl();
10577 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
10578 wxRichTextTable
* clone
= NULL
;
10579 if (!rtc
->SuppressingUndo())
10581 // Create a clone containing the current state of the table. It will be used to Undo the action
10582 clone
= wxStaticCast(this->Clone(), wxRichTextTable
);
10583 clone
->SetParent(GetParent());
10584 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Delete Row"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
, buffer
, this, rtc
);
10585 action
->SetObject(this);
10586 action
->SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
10590 for (i
= startRow
; i
< (startRow
+noRows
); i
++)
10592 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[startRow
];
10593 for (j
= 0; j
< (int) colArray
.GetCount(); j
++)
10595 wxRichTextObject
* cell
= colArray
[j
];
10596 RemoveChild(cell
, true);
10599 // Keep deleting at the same position, since we move all
10601 m_cells
.RemoveAt(startRow
);
10604 m_rowCount
= m_rowCount
- noRows
;
10606 if (!rtc
->SuppressingUndo())
10608 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
10609 // Finally store the original-state clone; doing so earlier would cause various failures
10610 action
->StoreObject(clone
);
10616 bool wxRichTextTable::DeleteColumns(int startCol
, int noCols
)
10618 wxASSERT((startCol
+ noCols
) <= m_colCount
);
10619 if ((startCol
+ noCols
) > m_colCount
)
10622 wxCHECK_MSG(noCols
!= m_colCount
, false, "Trying to delete all the cells in a table");
10624 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
10625 wxRichTextCtrl
* rtc
= buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl();
10627 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
10628 wxRichTextTable
* clone
= NULL
;
10629 if (!rtc
->SuppressingUndo())
10631 // Create a clone containing the current state of the table. It will be used to Undo the action
10632 clone
= wxStaticCast(this->Clone(), wxRichTextTable
);
10633 clone
->SetParent(GetParent());
10634 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Delete Column"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
, buffer
, this, rtc
);
10635 action
->SetObject(this);
10636 action
->SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
10639 bool deleteRows
= (noCols
== m_colCount
);
10642 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
10644 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[deleteRows
? 0 : i
];
10645 for (j
= 0; j
< noCols
; j
++)
10647 wxRichTextObject
* cell
= colArray
[startCol
];
10648 RemoveChild(cell
, true);
10649 colArray
.RemoveAt(startCol
);
10653 m_cells
.RemoveAt(0);
10658 m_colCount
= m_colCount
- noCols
;
10660 if (!rtc
->SuppressingUndo())
10662 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
10663 // Finally store the original-state clone; doing so earlier would cause various failures
10664 action
->StoreObject(clone
);
10670 bool wxRichTextTable::AddRows(int startRow
, int noRows
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
10672 wxASSERT(startRow
<= m_rowCount
);
10673 if (startRow
> m_rowCount
)
10676 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
10677 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
10678 wxRichTextTable
* clone
= NULL
;
10680 if (!buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->SuppressingUndo())
10682 // Create a clone containing the current state of the table. It will be used to Undo the action
10683 clone
= wxStaticCast(this->Clone(), wxRichTextTable
);
10684 clone
->SetParent(GetParent());
10685 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Add Row"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
10686 action
->SetObject(this);
10687 action
->SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
10690 wxRichTextAttr cellattr
= attr
;
10691 if (!cellattr
.GetTextColour().IsOk())
10692 cellattr
.SetTextColour(buffer
->GetBasicStyle().GetTextColour());
10695 for (i
= 0; i
< noRows
; i
++)
10698 if (startRow
== m_rowCount
)
10700 m_cells
.Add(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray());
10701 idx
= m_cells
.GetCount() - 1;
10705 m_cells
.Insert(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray(), startRow
+i
);
10709 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[idx
];
10710 for (j
= 0; j
< m_colCount
; j
++)
10712 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= new wxRichTextCell
;
10713 cell
->GetAttributes() = cellattr
;
10716 cell
->AddParagraph(wxEmptyString
);
10717 colArray
.Add(cell
);
10721 m_rowCount
= m_rowCount
+ noRows
;
10723 if (!buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->SuppressingUndo())
10725 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
10726 // Finally store the original-state clone; doing so earlier would cause various failures
10727 action
->StoreObject(clone
);
10733 bool wxRichTextTable::AddColumns(int startCol
, int noCols
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
10735 wxASSERT(startCol
<= m_colCount
);
10736 if (startCol
> m_colCount
)
10739 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
10740 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
10741 wxRichTextTable
* clone
= NULL
;
10743 if (!buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->SuppressingUndo())
10745 // Create a clone containing the current state of the table. It will be used to Undo the action
10746 clone
= wxStaticCast(this->Clone(), wxRichTextTable
);
10747 clone
->SetParent(GetParent());
10748 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Add Column"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
10749 action
->SetObject(this);
10750 action
->SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
10753 wxRichTextAttr cellattr
= attr
;
10754 if (!cellattr
.GetTextColour().IsOk())
10755 cellattr
.SetTextColour(buffer
->GetBasicStyle().GetTextColour());
10758 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
10760 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[i
];
10761 for (j
= 0; j
< noCols
; j
++)
10763 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= new wxRichTextCell
;
10764 cell
->GetAttributes() = cellattr
;
10767 cell
->AddParagraph(wxEmptyString
);
10769 if (startCol
== m_colCount
)
10770 colArray
.Add(cell
);
10772 colArray
.Insert(cell
, startCol
+j
);
10776 m_colCount
= m_colCount
+ noCols
;
10778 if (!buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->SuppressingUndo())
10780 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
10781 // Finally store the original-state clone; doing so earlier would cause various failures
10782 action
->StoreObject(clone
);
10788 // Edit properties via a GUI
10789 bool wxRichTextTable::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
10791 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
boxDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, _("Table Properties"));
10792 boxDlg
.SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
10794 if (boxDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
)
10796 boxDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
10803 bool wxRichTextTableBlock::ComputeBlockForSelection(wxRichTextTable
* table
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, bool requireCellSelection
)
10809 ColEnd() = table
->GetColumnCount()-1;
10811 RowEnd() = table
->GetRowCount()-1;
10813 wxRichTextSelection selection
= ctrl
->GetSelection();
10814 if (selection
.IsValid() && selection
.GetContainer() == table
)
10816 // Start with an invalid block and increase.
10817 wxRichTextTableBlock
selBlock(-1, -1, -1, -1);
10818 wxRichTextRangeArray ranges
= selection
.GetRanges();
10820 for (row
= 0; row
< table
->GetRowCount(); row
++)
10822 for (col
= 0; col
< table
->GetColumnCount(); col
++)
10824 if (selection
.WithinSelection(table
->GetCell(row
, col
)->GetRange().GetStart()))
10826 if (selBlock
.ColStart() == -1)
10827 selBlock
.ColStart() = col
;
10828 if (selBlock
.ColEnd() == -1)
10829 selBlock
.ColEnd() = col
;
10830 if (col
< selBlock
.ColStart())
10831 selBlock
.ColStart() = col
;
10832 if (col
> selBlock
.ColEnd())
10833 selBlock
.ColEnd() = col
;
10835 if (selBlock
.RowStart() == -1)
10836 selBlock
.RowStart() = row
;
10837 if (selBlock
.RowEnd() == -1)
10838 selBlock
.RowEnd() = row
;
10839 if (row
< selBlock
.RowStart())
10840 selBlock
.RowStart() = row
;
10841 if (row
> selBlock
.RowEnd())
10842 selBlock
.RowEnd() = row
;
10847 if (selBlock
.RowStart() != -1 && selBlock
.RowEnd() != -1 && selBlock
.ColStart() != -1 && selBlock
.ColEnd() != -1)
10848 (*this) = selBlock
;
10852 // See if a whole cell's contents is selected, in which case we can treat the cell as selected.
10853 // wxRTC lacks the ability to select a single cell.
10854 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= wxDynamicCast(ctrl
->GetFocusObject(), wxRichTextCell
);
10855 if (cell
&& (!requireCellSelection
|| (ctrl
->HasSelection() && ctrl
->GetSelectionRange() == cell
->GetOwnRange())))
10858 if (table
->GetCellRowColumnPosition(cell
->GetRange().GetStart(), row
, col
))
10871 // Does this block represent the whole table?
10872 bool wxRichTextTableBlock::IsWholeTable(wxRichTextTable
* table
) const
10874 return (ColStart() == 0 && RowStart() == 0 && ColEnd() == (table
->GetColumnCount()-1) && RowEnd() == (table
->GetRowCount()-1));
10877 // Returns the cell focused in the table, if any
10878 wxRichTextCell
* wxRichTextTableBlock::GetFocusedCell(wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
)
10883 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= wxDynamicCast(ctrl
->GetFocusObject(), wxRichTextCell
);
10888 * Module to initialise and clean up handlers
10891 class wxRichTextModule
: public wxModule
10893 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextModule
)
10895 wxRichTextModule() {}
10898 wxRichTextBuffer::SetRenderer(new wxRichTextStdRenderer
);
10899 wxRichTextBuffer::InitStandardHandlers();
10900 wxRichTextParagraph::InitDefaultTabs();
10902 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("text"), wxT("wxRichTextPlainText"));
10903 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("symbol"), wxT("wxRichTextPlainText"));
10904 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("image"), wxT("wxRichTextImage"));
10905 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("paragraph"), wxT("wxRichTextParagraph"));
10906 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("paragraphlayout"), wxT("wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox"));
10907 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("textbox"), wxT("wxRichTextBox"));
10908 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("cell"), wxT("wxRichTextCell"));
10909 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("table"), wxT("wxRichTextTable"));
10910 wxRichTextXMLHandler::RegisterNodeName(wxT("field"), wxT("wxRichTextField"));
10916 wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpHandlers();
10917 wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpDrawingHandlers();
10918 wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpFieldTypes();
10919 wxRichTextXMLHandler::ClearNodeToClassMap();
10920 wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(-1);
10921 wxRichTextParagraph::ClearDefaultTabs();
10922 wxRichTextCtrl::ClearAvailableFontNames();
10923 wxRichTextBuffer::SetRenderer(NULL
);
10927 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextModule
, wxModule
)
10930 // If the richtext lib is dynamically loaded after the app has already started
10931 // (such as from wxPython) then the built-in module system will not init this
10932 // module. Provide this function to do it manually.
10933 void wxRichTextModuleInit()
10935 wxModule
* module = new wxRichTextModule
;
10936 wxModule::RegisterModule(module);
10937 wxModule::InitializeModules();
10942 * Commands for undo/redo
10946 wxRichTextCommand::wxRichTextCommand(const wxString
& name
, wxRichTextCommandId id
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
,
10947 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, bool ignoreFirstTime
): wxCommand(true, name
)
10949 /* wxRichTextAction* action = */ new wxRichTextAction(this, name
, id
, buffer
, container
, ctrl
, ignoreFirstTime
);
10952 wxRichTextCommand::wxRichTextCommand(const wxString
& name
): wxCommand(true, name
)
10956 wxRichTextCommand::~wxRichTextCommand()
10961 void wxRichTextCommand::AddAction(wxRichTextAction
* action
)
10963 if (!m_actions
.Member(action
))
10964 m_actions
.Append(action
);
10967 bool wxRichTextCommand::Do()
10969 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_actions
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
10971 wxRichTextAction
* action
= (wxRichTextAction
*) node
->GetData();
10978 bool wxRichTextCommand::Undo()
10980 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_actions
.GetLast(); node
; node
= node
->GetPrevious())
10982 wxRichTextAction
* action
= (wxRichTextAction
*) node
->GetData();
10989 void wxRichTextCommand::ClearActions()
10991 WX_CLEAR_LIST(wxList
, m_actions
);
10995 * Individual action
10999 wxRichTextAction::wxRichTextAction(wxRichTextCommand
* cmd
, const wxString
& name
, wxRichTextCommandId id
,
11000 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
,
11001 wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, bool ignoreFirstTime
)
11005 m_containerAddress
.Create(buffer
, container
);
11006 m_ignoreThis
= ignoreFirstTime
;
11011 m_newParagraphs
.SetDefaultStyle(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
11012 m_newParagraphs
.SetBasicStyle(buffer
->GetBasicStyle());
11014 cmd
->AddAction(this);
11017 wxRichTextAction::~wxRichTextAction()
11023 // Returns the container that this action refers to, using the container address and top-level buffer.
11024 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* wxRichTextAction::GetContainer() const
11026 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= wxDynamicCast(GetContainerAddress().GetObject(m_buffer
), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
11031 void wxRichTextAction::CalculateRefreshOptimizations(wxArrayInt
& optimizationLineCharPositions
, wxArrayInt
& optimizationLineYPositions
)
11033 // Store a list of line start character and y positions so we can figure out which area
11034 // we need to refresh
11036 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
11037 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
11038 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
11042 // NOTE: we're assuming that the buffer is laid out correctly at this point.
11043 // If we had several actions, which only invalidate and leave layout until the
11044 // paint handler is called, then this might not be true. So we may need to switch
11045 // optimisation on only when we're simply adding text and not simultaneously
11046 // deleting a selection, for example. Or, we make sure the buffer is laid out correctly
11047 // first, but of course this means we'll be doing it twice.
11048 if (!m_buffer
->IsDirty() && m_ctrl
) // can only do optimisation if the buffer is already laid out correctly
11050 wxSize clientSize
= m_ctrl
->GetUnscaledSize(m_ctrl
->GetClientSize());
11051 wxPoint firstVisiblePt
= m_ctrl
->GetUnscaledPoint(m_ctrl
->GetFirstVisiblePoint());
11052 int lastY
= firstVisiblePt
.y
+ clientSize
.y
;
11054 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= container
->GetParagraphAtPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11055 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= container
->GetChildren().Find(para
);
11058 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= (wxRichTextParagraph
*) node
->GetData();
11059 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
11062 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
11063 wxPoint pt
= line
->GetAbsolutePosition();
11064 wxRichTextRange range
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
11068 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
11069 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
11071 else if (range
.GetStart() > GetPosition() && pt
.y
>= firstVisiblePt
.y
)
11073 optimizationLineCharPositions
.Add(range
.GetStart());
11074 optimizationLineYPositions
.Add(pt
.y
);
11078 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
11082 node
= node
->GetNext();
11088 bool wxRichTextAction::Do()
11090 m_buffer
->Modify(true);
11092 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
11093 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
11099 case wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
:
11101 // Store a list of line start character and y positions so we can figure out which area
11102 // we need to refresh
11103 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
11104 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
11106 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
11107 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
11110 container
->InsertFragment(GetRange().GetStart(), m_newParagraphs
);
11111 container
->UpdateRanges();
11113 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11114 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11115 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRichTextRange(wxMax(0, GetRange().GetStart()-1), GetRange().GetEnd()));
11117 long newCaretPosition
= GetPosition() + m_newParagraphs
.GetOwnRange().GetLength();
11119 // Character position to caret position
11120 newCaretPosition
--;
11122 // Don't take into account the last newline
11123 if (m_newParagraphs
.GetPartialParagraph())
11124 newCaretPosition
--;
11126 if (m_newParagraphs
.GetChildren().GetCount() > 1)
11128 wxRichTextObject
* p
= (wxRichTextObject
*) m_newParagraphs
.GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData();
11129 if (p
->GetRange().GetLength() == 1)
11130 newCaretPosition
--;
11133 newCaretPosition
= wxMin(newCaretPosition
, (container
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd()-1));
11135 UpdateAppearance(newCaretPosition
, true /* send update event */, & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, true /* do */);
11137 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
11138 wxEVT_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_INSERTED
,
11139 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
11140 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
11141 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
11142 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11143 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
11145 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
11149 case wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
:
11151 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
11152 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
11154 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
11155 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
11158 container
->DeleteRange(GetRange());
11159 container
->UpdateRanges();
11160 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11161 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11162 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRichTextRange(GetRange().GetStart(), GetRange().GetStart()));
11164 long caretPos
= GetRange().GetStart()-1;
11165 if (caretPos
>= container
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd())
11168 UpdateAppearance(caretPos
, true /* send update event */, & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, true /* do */);
11170 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
11171 wxEVT_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_DELETED
,
11172 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
11173 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
11174 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
11175 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11176 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
11178 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
11182 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
:
11183 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_PROPERTIES
:
11185 ApplyParagraphs(GetNewParagraphs());
11187 // Invalidate the whole buffer if there were floating objects
11188 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && container
->GetFloatingObjectCount() > 0)
11189 m_buffer
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
11192 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11193 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11194 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
11197 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition());
11199 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
11200 m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
? wxEVT_RICHTEXT_STYLE_CHANGED
: wxEVT_RICHTEXT_PROPERTIES_CHANGED
,
11201 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
11202 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
11203 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
11204 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11205 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
11207 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
11211 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES
:
11213 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= m_objectAddress
.GetObject(m_buffer
); // container->GetChildAtPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11216 wxRichTextAttr oldAttr
= obj
->GetAttributes();
11217 obj
->GetAttributes() = m_attributes
;
11218 m_attributes
= oldAttr
;
11221 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11222 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11223 // Invalidate the whole buffer if there were floating objects
11224 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && container
->GetFloatingObjectCount() > 0)
11225 m_buffer
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
11227 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
11229 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition());
11231 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
11232 wxEVT_RICHTEXT_STYLE_CHANGED
,
11233 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
11234 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
11235 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
11236 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11237 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
11239 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
11243 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
:
11245 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= m_objectAddress
.GetObject(m_buffer
);
11246 if (obj
&& m_object
&& m_ctrl
)
11248 // The plan is to swap the current object with the stored, previous-state, clone
11249 // We can't get 'node' from the containing buffer (as it doesn't directly store objects)
11250 // so use the parent paragraph
11251 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(obj
->GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
11252 wxCHECK_MSG(para
, false, "Invalid parent paragraph");
11254 // The stored object, m_object, may have a stale parent paragraph. This would cause
11255 // a crash during layout, so use obj's parent para, which should be the correct one.
11256 // (An alternative would be to return the parent too from m_objectAddress.GetObject(),
11257 // or to set obj's parent there before returning)
11258 m_object
->SetParent(para
);
11260 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= para
->GetChildren().Find(obj
);
11263 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
11264 node
->SetData(m_object
);
11269 // We can't rely on the current focus-object remaining valid, if it's e.g. a table's cell.
11270 // And we can't cope with this in the calling code: a user may later click in the cell
11271 // before deciding to Undo() or Redo(). So play safe and set focus to the buffer.
11273 m_ctrl
->SetFocusObject(m_buffer
, false);
11275 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11276 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11277 // Invalidate the whole buffer if there were floating objects
11278 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && container
->GetFloatingObjectCount() > 0)
11279 m_buffer
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
11281 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
11283 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition(), true);
11285 // TODO: send new kind of modification event
11296 bool wxRichTextAction::Undo()
11298 m_buffer
->Modify(true);
11300 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
11301 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
11307 case wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
:
11309 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
11310 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
11312 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
11313 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
11316 container
->DeleteRange(GetRange());
11317 container
->UpdateRanges();
11319 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11320 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11321 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRichTextRange(GetRange().GetStart(), GetRange().GetStart()));
11323 long newCaretPosition
= GetPosition() - 1;
11325 UpdateAppearance(newCaretPosition
, true, /* send update event */ & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, false /* undo */);
11327 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
11328 wxEVT_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_DELETED
,
11329 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
11330 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
11331 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
11332 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11333 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
11335 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
11339 case wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
:
11341 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
11342 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
11344 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
11345 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
11348 container
->InsertFragment(GetRange().GetStart(), m_oldParagraphs
);
11349 container
->UpdateRanges();
11351 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11352 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11353 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
11355 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition(), true, /* send update event */ & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, false /* undo */);
11357 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
11358 wxEVT_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_INSERTED
,
11359 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
11360 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
11361 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
11362 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11363 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
11365 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
11369 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
:
11370 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_PROPERTIES
:
11372 ApplyParagraphs(GetOldParagraphs());
11373 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
11374 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
11375 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
11377 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition());
11379 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
11380 m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
? wxEVT_RICHTEXT_STYLE_CHANGED
: wxEVT_RICHTEXT_PROPERTIES_CHANGED
,
11381 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
11382 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
11383 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
11384 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
11385 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
11387 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
11391 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES
:
11392 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
:
11403 /// Update the control appearance
11404 void wxRichTextAction::UpdateAppearance(long caretPosition
, bool sendUpdateEvent
, wxArrayInt
* optimizationLineCharPositions
, wxArrayInt
* optimizationLineYPositions
, bool isDoCmd
)
11406 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
11407 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
11413 m_ctrl
->SetFocusObject(container
);
11414 m_ctrl
->SetCaretPosition(caretPosition
);
11416 if (!m_ctrl
->IsFrozen())
11418 wxRect containerRect
= container
->GetRect();
11420 m_ctrl
->LayoutContent();
11422 // Refresh everything if there were floating objects or the container changed size
11423 // (we can't yet optimize in these cases, since more complex interaction with other content occurs)
11424 if ((wxRichTextBuffer::GetFloatingLayoutMode() && container
->GetFloatingObjectCount() > 0) || (container
->GetParent() && containerRect
!= container
->GetRect()))
11426 m_ctrl
->Refresh(false);
11430 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
11431 // Find refresh rectangle if we are in a position to optimise refresh
11432 if ((m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
|| m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
) && optimizationLineCharPositions
)
11436 wxSize clientSize
= m_ctrl
->GetUnscaledSize(m_ctrl
->GetClientSize());
11437 wxPoint firstVisiblePt
= m_ctrl
->GetUnscaledPoint(m_ctrl
->GetFirstVisiblePoint());
11439 // Start/end positions
11441 int lastY
= firstVisiblePt
.y
+ clientSize
.y
;
11443 bool foundEnd
= false;
11445 // position offset - how many characters were inserted
11446 int positionOffset
= GetRange().GetLength();
11448 // Determine whether this is Do or Undo, and adjust positionOffset accordingly
11449 if ((m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
&& isDoCmd
) || (m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
&& !isDoCmd
))
11450 positionOffset
= - positionOffset
;
11452 // find the first line which is being drawn at the same position as it was
11453 // before. Since we're talking about a simple insertion, we can assume
11454 // that the rest of the window does not need to be redrawn.
11455 long pos
= GetRange().GetStart();
11457 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= container
->GetParagraphAtPosition(pos
, false /* is not caret pos */);
11458 // Since we support floating layout, we should redraw the whole para instead of just
11459 // the first line touching the invalid range.
11462 // In case something was drawn above the paragraph,
11463 // such as a line break, allow a little extra.
11464 firstY
= para
->GetPosition().y
- 4;
11467 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= container
->GetChildren().Find(para
);
11470 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= (wxRichTextParagraph
*) node
->GetData();
11471 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
11474 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
11475 wxPoint pt
= line
->GetAbsolutePosition();
11476 wxRichTextRange range
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
11478 // we want to find the first line that is in the same position
11479 // as before. This will mean we're at the end of the changed text.
11481 if (pt
.y
> lastY
) // going past the end of the window, no more info
11483 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
11484 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
11486 // Detect last line in the buffer
11487 else if (!node2
->GetNext() && para
->GetRange().Contains(container
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd()))
11489 // If deleting text, make sure we refresh below as well as above
11490 if (positionOffset
>= 0)
11493 lastY
= pt
.y
+ line
->GetSize().y
;
11496 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
11497 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
11503 // search for this line being at the same position as before
11504 for (i
= 0; i
< optimizationLineCharPositions
->GetCount(); i
++)
11506 if (((*optimizationLineCharPositions
)[i
] + positionOffset
== range
.GetStart()) &&
11507 ((*optimizationLineYPositions
)[i
] == pt
.y
))
11509 // Stop, we're now the same as we were
11512 lastY
= pt
.y
+ line
->GetSize().y
;
11514 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
11515 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
11523 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
11527 node
= node
->GetNext();
11530 firstY
= wxMax(firstVisiblePt
.y
, firstY
);
11532 lastY
= firstVisiblePt
.y
+ clientSize
.y
;
11534 // Convert to device coordinates
11535 wxRect
rect(m_ctrl
->GetPhysicalPoint(m_ctrl
->GetScaledPoint(wxPoint(firstVisiblePt
.x
, firstY
))), m_ctrl
->GetScaledSize(wxSize(clientSize
.x
, lastY
- firstY
)));
11536 m_ctrl
->RefreshRect(rect
);
11540 m_ctrl
->Refresh(false);
11542 m_ctrl
->PositionCaret();
11544 // This causes styles to persist when doing programmatic
11545 // content creation except when Freeze/Thaw is used, so
11546 // disable this and check for the consequences.
11547 // m_ctrl->SetDefaultStyleToCursorStyle();
11549 if (sendUpdateEvent
)
11550 wxTextCtrl::SendTextUpdatedEvent(m_ctrl
);
11555 /// Replace the buffer paragraphs with the new ones.
11556 void wxRichTextAction::ApplyParagraphs(const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& fragment
)
11558 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
11559 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
11563 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
11566 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
11567 wxASSERT (para
!= NULL
);
11569 // We'll replace the existing paragraph by finding the paragraph at this position,
11570 // delete its node data, and setting a copy as the new node data.
11571 // TODO: make more efficient by simply swapping old and new paragraph objects.
11573 wxRichTextParagraph
* existingPara
= container
->GetParagraphAtPosition(para
->GetRange().GetStart());
11576 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator bufferParaNode
= container
->GetChildren().Find(existingPara
);
11577 if (bufferParaNode
)
11579 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
11580 newPara
->SetParent(container
);
11582 bufferParaNode
->SetData(newPara
);
11584 delete existingPara
;
11588 node
= node
->GetNext();
11595 * This stores beginning and end positions for a range of data.
11598 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextRangeArray
);
11600 /// Limit this range to be within 'range'
11601 bool wxRichTextRange::LimitTo(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
11603 if (m_start
< range
.m_start
)
11604 m_start
= range
.m_start
;
11606 if (m_end
> range
.m_end
)
11607 m_end
= range
.m_end
;
11613 * wxRichTextImage implementation
11614 * This object represents an image.
11617 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextImage
, wxRichTextObject
)
11619 wxRichTextImage::wxRichTextImage(const wxImage
& image
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* charStyle
):
11620 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
11623 m_imageBlock
.MakeImageBlockDefaultQuality(image
, wxBITMAP_TYPE_PNG
);
11625 SetAttributes(*charStyle
);
11628 wxRichTextImage::wxRichTextImage(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& imageBlock
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* charStyle
):
11629 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
11632 m_imageBlock
= imageBlock
;
11634 SetAttributes(*charStyle
);
11637 wxRichTextImage::~wxRichTextImage()
11641 void wxRichTextImage::Init()
11643 m_originalImageSize
= wxSize(-1, -1);
11646 /// Create a cached image at the required size
11647 bool wxRichTextImage::LoadImageCache(wxDC
& dc
, bool resetCache
, const wxSize
& parentSize
)
11649 if (!m_imageBlock
.IsOk())
11652 // If we have an original image size, use that to compute the cached bitmap size
11653 // instead of loading the image each time. This way we can avoid loading
11654 // the image so long as the new cached bitmap size hasn't changed.
11657 if (resetCache
|| m_originalImageSize
.GetWidth() <= 0 || m_originalImageSize
.GetHeight() <= 0)
11659 m_imageCache
= wxNullBitmap
;
11661 m_imageBlock
.Load(image
);
11665 m_originalImageSize
= wxSize(image
.GetWidth(), image
.GetHeight());
11668 int width
= m_originalImageSize
.GetWidth();
11669 int height
= m_originalImageSize
.GetHeight();
11671 int parentWidth
= 0;
11672 int parentHeight
= 0;
11675 int maxHeight
= -1;
11677 wxSize sz
= parentSize
;
11678 if (sz
== wxDefaultSize
)
11680 if (GetParent() && GetParent()->GetParent())
11681 sz
= GetParent()->GetParent()->GetCachedSize();
11684 if (sz
!= wxDefaultSize
)
11686 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
11689 // Find the actual space available when margin is taken into account
11690 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
11691 marginRect
= wxRect(0, 0, sz
.x
, sz
.y
);
11692 if (GetParent() && GetParent()->GetParent())
11694 buffer
->GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, GetParent()->GetParent()->GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
11695 sz
= contentRect
.GetSize();
11698 // Use a minimum size to stop images becoming very small
11699 parentWidth
= wxMax(100, sz
.GetWidth());
11700 parentHeight
= wxMax(100, sz
.GetHeight());
11702 if (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl())
11703 // Start with a maximum width of the control size, even if not specified by the content,
11704 // to minimize the amount of picture overlapping the right-hand side
11705 maxWidth
= parentWidth
;
11709 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid() && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetValue() > 0)
11711 if (parentWidth
> 0 && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
11712 width
= (int) ((GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetValue() * parentWidth
)/100.0);
11713 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
11714 width
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetValue());
11715 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
11716 width
= GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetValue();
11719 // Limit to max width
11721 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().IsValid() && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().GetValue() > 0)
11725 if (parentWidth
> 0 && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
11726 mw
= (int) ((GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().GetValue() * parentWidth
)/100.0);
11727 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
11728 mw
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().GetValue());
11729 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
11730 mw
= GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetWidth().GetValue();
11732 // If we already have a smaller max width due to the constraints of the control size,
11733 // don't use the larger max width.
11734 if (mw
!= -1 && ((maxWidth
== -1) || (mw
< maxWidth
)))
11738 if (maxWidth
> 0 && width
> maxWidth
)
11741 // Preserve the aspect ratio
11742 if (width
!= m_originalImageSize
.GetWidth())
11743 height
= (int) (float(m_originalImageSize
.GetHeight()) * (float(width
)/float(m_originalImageSize
.GetWidth())));
11745 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().IsValid() && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetValue() > 0)
11747 if (parentHeight
> 0 && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
11748 height
= (int) ((GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetValue() * parentHeight
)/100.0);
11749 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
11750 height
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetValue());
11751 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
11752 height
= GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetValue();
11754 // Preserve the aspect ratio
11755 if (height
!= m_originalImageSize
.GetHeight())
11756 width
= (int) (float(m_originalImageSize
.GetWidth()) * (float(height
)/float(m_originalImageSize
.GetHeight())));
11759 // Limit to max height
11761 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().IsValid() && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().GetValue() > 0)
11763 if (parentHeight
> 0 && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
11764 maxHeight
= (int) ((GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().GetValue() * parentHeight
)/100.0);
11765 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
11766 maxHeight
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().GetValue());
11767 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
11768 maxHeight
= GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMaxSize().GetHeight().GetValue();
11771 if (maxHeight
> 0 && height
> maxHeight
)
11773 height
= maxHeight
;
11775 // Preserve the aspect ratio
11776 if (height
!= m_originalImageSize
.GetHeight())
11777 width
= (int) (float(m_originalImageSize
.GetWidth()) * (float(height
)/float(m_originalImageSize
.GetHeight())));
11780 // Prevent the use of zero size
11781 width
= wxMax(1, width
);
11782 height
= wxMax(1, height
);
11784 if (m_imageCache
.IsOk() && m_imageCache
.GetWidth() == width
&& m_imageCache
.GetHeight() == height
)
11786 // Do nothing, we didn't need to change the image cache
11792 m_imageBlock
.Load(image
);
11797 if (image
.GetWidth() == width
&& image
.GetHeight() == height
)
11798 m_imageCache
= wxBitmap(image
);
11801 // If the original width and height is small, e.g. 400 or below,
11802 // scale up and then down to improve image quality. This can make
11803 // a big difference, with not much performance hit.
11804 int upscaleThreshold
= 400;
11806 if (image
.GetWidth() <= upscaleThreshold
|| image
.GetHeight() <= upscaleThreshold
)
11808 img
= image
.Scale(image
.GetWidth()*2, image
.GetHeight()*2);
11809 img
.Rescale(width
, height
, wxIMAGE_QUALITY_HIGH
);
11812 img
= image
.Scale(width
, height
, wxIMAGE_QUALITY_HIGH
);
11813 m_imageCache
= wxBitmap(img
);
11817 return m_imageCache
.IsOk();
11821 bool wxRichTextImage::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRichTextRange
& WXUNUSED(range
), const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int WXUNUSED(descent
), int WXUNUSED(style
))
11826 // Don't need cached size AFAIK
11827 // wxSize size = GetCachedSize();
11828 if (!LoadImageCache(dc
))
11831 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetAttributes());
11832 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, this);
11834 DrawBoxAttributes(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, wxRect(rect
.GetPosition(), GetCachedSize()));
11836 wxSize
imageSize(m_imageCache
.GetWidth(), m_imageCache
.GetHeight());
11837 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
11838 marginRect
= rect
; // outer rectangle, will calculate contentRect
11839 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
11841 dc
.DrawBitmap(m_imageCache
, contentRect
.x
, contentRect
.y
, true);
11843 if (selection
.WithinSelection(GetRange().GetStart(), this))
11845 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, *wxBLACK_BRUSH
);
11846 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, *wxBLACK_PEN
);
11847 dc
.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT
);
11848 dc
.DrawRectangle(contentRect
);
11849 dc
.SetLogicalFunction(wxCOPY
);
11855 /// Lay the item out
11856 bool wxRichTextImage::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(parentRect
), int WXUNUSED(style
))
11858 if (!LoadImageCache(dc
))
11861 wxSize
imageSize(m_imageCache
.GetWidth(), m_imageCache
.GetHeight());
11862 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
11863 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0,0), imageSize
);
11865 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetAttributes());
11866 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, this);
11868 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
11870 wxSize overallSize
= marginRect
.GetSize();
11872 SetCachedSize(overallSize
);
11873 SetMaxSize(overallSize
);
11874 SetMinSize(overallSize
);
11875 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
11880 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
11881 /// is invalid for this object.
11882 bool wxRichTextImage::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& WXUNUSED(descent
), wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextDrawingContext
& context
, int WXUNUSED(flags
), const wxPoint
& WXUNUSED(position
), const wxSize
& parentSize
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
11884 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
11887 if (!((wxRichTextImage
*)this)->LoadImageCache(dc
, false, parentSize
))
11889 size
.x
= 0; size
.y
= 0;
11890 if (partialExtents
)
11891 partialExtents
->Add(0);
11895 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetAttributes());
11896 context
.ApplyVirtualAttributes(attr
, (wxRichTextObject
*) this);
11898 wxSize
imageSize(m_imageCache
.GetWidth(), m_imageCache
.GetHeight());
11899 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
11900 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0,0), imageSize
);
11901 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
11903 wxSize overallSize
= marginRect
.GetSize();
11905 if (partialExtents
)
11906 partialExtents
->Add(overallSize
.x
);
11908 size
= overallSize
;
11913 // Get the 'natural' size for an object. For an image, it would be the
11915 wxTextAttrSize
wxRichTextImage::GetNaturalSize() const
11917 wxTextAttrSize size
;
11918 if (GetImageCache().IsOk())
11920 size
.SetWidth(GetImageCache().GetWidth(), wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
11921 size
.SetHeight(GetImageCache().GetHeight(), wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
11928 void wxRichTextImage::Copy(const wxRichTextImage
& obj
)
11930 wxRichTextObject::Copy(obj
);
11932 m_imageBlock
= obj
.m_imageBlock
;
11933 m_originalImageSize
= obj
.m_originalImageSize
;
11936 /// Edit properties via a GUI
11937 bool wxRichTextImage::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
11939 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
imageDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, _("Picture Properties"));
11940 imageDlg
.SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
11942 if (imageDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
)
11944 // By passing wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET, indeterminate attributes set by the user will be set as
11945 // indeterminate in the object.
11946 imageDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
11958 /// Compare two attribute objects
11959 bool wxTextAttrEq(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr1
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr2
)
11961 return (attr1
== attr2
);
11965 bool wxRichTextTabsEq(const wxArrayInt
& tabs1
, const wxArrayInt
& tabs2
)
11967 if (tabs1
.GetCount() != tabs2
.GetCount())
11971 for (i
= 0; i
< tabs1
.GetCount(); i
++)
11973 if (tabs1
[i
] != tabs2
[i
])
11979 bool wxRichTextApplyStyle(wxRichTextAttr
& destStyle
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, wxRichTextAttr
* compareWith
)
11981 return destStyle
.Apply(style
, compareWith
);
11984 // Remove attributes
11985 bool wxRichTextRemoveStyle(wxRichTextAttr
& destStyle
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
11987 return destStyle
.RemoveStyle(style
);
11990 /// Combine two bitlists, specifying the bits of interest with separate flags.
11991 bool wxRichTextCombineBitlists(int& valueA
, int valueB
, int& flagsA
, int flagsB
)
11993 return wxRichTextAttr::CombineBitlists(valueA
, valueB
, flagsA
, flagsB
);
11996 /// Compare two bitlists
11997 bool wxRichTextBitlistsEqPartial(int valueA
, int valueB
, int flags
)
11999 return wxRichTextAttr::BitlistsEqPartial(valueA
, valueB
, flags
);
12002 /// Split into paragraph and character styles
12003 bool wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, wxRichTextAttr
& parStyle
, wxRichTextAttr
& charStyle
)
12005 return wxRichTextAttr::SplitParaCharStyles(style
, parStyle
, charStyle
);
12008 /// Convert a decimal to Roman numerals
12009 wxString
wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(long n
)
12011 static wxArrayInt decimalNumbers
;
12012 static wxArrayString romanNumbers
;
12017 decimalNumbers
.Clear();
12018 romanNumbers
.Clear();
12019 return wxEmptyString
;
12022 if (decimalNumbers
.GetCount() == 0)
12024 #define wxRichTextAddDecRom(n, r) decimalNumbers.Add(n); romanNumbers.Add(r);
12026 wxRichTextAddDecRom(1000, wxT("M"));
12027 wxRichTextAddDecRom(900, wxT("CM"));
12028 wxRichTextAddDecRom(500, wxT("D"));
12029 wxRichTextAddDecRom(400, wxT("CD"));
12030 wxRichTextAddDecRom(100, wxT("C"));
12031 wxRichTextAddDecRom(90, wxT("XC"));
12032 wxRichTextAddDecRom(50, wxT("L"));
12033 wxRichTextAddDecRom(40, wxT("XL"));
12034 wxRichTextAddDecRom(10, wxT("X"));
12035 wxRichTextAddDecRom(9, wxT("IX"));
12036 wxRichTextAddDecRom(5, wxT("V"));
12037 wxRichTextAddDecRom(4, wxT("IV"));
12038 wxRichTextAddDecRom(1, wxT("I"));
12044 while (n
> 0 && i
< 13)
12046 if (n
>= decimalNumbers
[i
])
12048 n
-= decimalNumbers
[i
];
12049 roman
+= romanNumbers
[i
];
12056 if (roman
.IsEmpty())
12062 * wxRichTextFileHandler
12063 * Base class for file handlers
12066 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextFileHandler
, wxObject
)
12068 #if wxUSE_FFILE && wxUSE_STREAMS
12069 bool wxRichTextFileHandler::LoadFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, const wxString
& filename
)
12071 wxFFileInputStream
stream(filename
);
12073 return LoadFile(buffer
, stream
);
12078 bool wxRichTextFileHandler::SaveFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, const wxString
& filename
)
12080 wxFFileOutputStream
stream(filename
);
12082 return SaveFile(buffer
, stream
);
12086 #endif // wxUSE_FFILE && wxUSE_STREAMS
12088 /// Can we handle this filename (if using files)? By default, checks the extension.
12089 bool wxRichTextFileHandler::CanHandle(const wxString
& filename
) const
12091 wxString path
, file
, ext
;
12092 wxFileName::SplitPath(filename
, & path
, & file
, & ext
);
12094 return (ext
.Lower() == GetExtension());
12098 * wxRichTextTextHandler
12099 * Plain text handler
12102 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextPlainTextHandler
, wxRichTextFileHandler
)
12105 bool wxRichTextPlainTextHandler::DoLoadFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, wxInputStream
& stream
)
12107 if (!stream
.IsOk())
12113 while (!stream
.Eof())
12115 int ch
= stream
.GetC();
12119 if (ch
== 10 && lastCh
!= 13)
12122 if (ch
> 0 && ch
!= 10)
12129 buffer
->ResetAndClearCommands();
12131 buffer
->AddParagraphs(str
);
12132 buffer
->UpdateRanges();
12137 bool wxRichTextPlainTextHandler::DoSaveFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, wxOutputStream
& stream
)
12139 if (!stream
.IsOk())
12142 wxString text
= buffer
->GetText();
12144 wxString newLine
= wxRichTextLineBreakChar
;
12145 text
.Replace(newLine
, wxT("\n"));
12147 wxCharBuffer buf
= text
.ToAscii();
12149 stream
.Write((const char*) buf
, text
.length());
12152 #endif // wxUSE_STREAMS
12155 * Stores information about an image, in binary in-memory form
12158 wxRichTextImageBlock::wxRichTextImageBlock()
12163 wxRichTextImageBlock::wxRichTextImageBlock(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& block
):wxObject()
12169 wxRichTextImageBlock::~wxRichTextImageBlock()
12174 void wxRichTextImageBlock::Init()
12178 m_imageType
= wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
;
12181 void wxRichTextImageBlock::Clear()
12185 m_imageType
= wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
;
12189 // Load the original image into a memory block.
12190 // If the image is not a JPEG, we must convert it into a JPEG
12191 // to conserve space.
12192 // If it's not a JPEG we can make use of 'image', already scaled, so we don't have to
12193 // load the image a 2nd time.
12195 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::MakeImageBlock(const wxString
& filename
, wxBitmapType imageType
,
12196 wxImage
& image
, bool convertToJPEG
)
12198 m_imageType
= imageType
;
12200 wxString
filenameToRead(filename
);
12201 bool removeFile
= false;
12203 if (imageType
== wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
)
12204 return false; // Could not determine image type
12206 if ((imageType
!= wxBITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
) && convertToJPEG
)
12208 wxString tempFile
=
12209 wxFileName::CreateTempFileName(_("image"));
12211 wxASSERT(!tempFile
.IsEmpty());
12213 image
.SaveFile(tempFile
, wxBITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
);
12214 filenameToRead
= tempFile
;
12217 m_imageType
= wxBITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
;
12220 if (!file
.Open(filenameToRead
))
12223 m_dataSize
= (size_t) file
.Length();
12228 m_data
= ReadBlock(filenameToRead
, m_dataSize
);
12231 wxRemoveFile(filenameToRead
);
12233 return (m_data
!= NULL
);
12236 // Make an image block from the wxImage in the given
12238 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::MakeImageBlock(wxImage
& image
, wxBitmapType imageType
, int quality
)
12240 image
.SetOption(wxT("quality"), quality
);
12242 if (imageType
== wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
)
12243 return false; // Could not determine image type
12245 return DoMakeImageBlock(image
, imageType
);
12248 // Uses a const wxImage for efficiency, but can't set quality (only relevant for JPEG)
12249 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::MakeImageBlockDefaultQuality(const wxImage
& image
, wxBitmapType imageType
)
12251 if (imageType
== wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
)
12252 return false; // Could not determine image type
12254 return DoMakeImageBlock(image
, imageType
);
12257 // Makes the image block
12258 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::DoMakeImageBlock(const wxImage
& image
, wxBitmapType imageType
)
12260 wxMemoryOutputStream memStream
;
12261 if (!image
.SaveFile(memStream
, imageType
))
12266 unsigned char* block
= new unsigned char[memStream
.GetSize()];
12274 m_imageType
= imageType
;
12275 m_dataSize
= memStream
.GetSize();
12277 memStream
.CopyTo(m_data
, m_dataSize
);
12279 return (m_data
!= NULL
);
12283 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::Write(const wxString
& filename
)
12285 return WriteBlock(filename
, m_data
, m_dataSize
);
12288 void wxRichTextImageBlock::Copy(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& block
)
12290 m_imageType
= block
.m_imageType
;
12292 m_dataSize
= block
.m_dataSize
;
12293 if (m_dataSize
== 0)
12296 m_data
= new unsigned char[m_dataSize
];
12298 for (i
= 0; i
< m_dataSize
; i
++)
12299 m_data
[i
] = block
.m_data
[i
];
12303 void wxRichTextImageBlock::operator=(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& block
)
12308 // Load a wxImage from the block
12309 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::Load(wxImage
& image
)
12314 // Read in the image.
12316 wxMemoryInputStream
mstream(m_data
, m_dataSize
);
12317 bool success
= image
.LoadFile(mstream
, GetImageType());
12319 wxString tempFile
= wxFileName::CreateTempFileName(_("image"));
12320 wxASSERT(!tempFile
.IsEmpty());
12322 if (!WriteBlock(tempFile
, m_data
, m_dataSize
))
12326 success
= image
.LoadFile(tempFile
, GetImageType());
12327 wxRemoveFile(tempFile
);
12333 // Write data in hex to a stream
12334 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::WriteHex(wxOutputStream
& stream
)
12336 if (m_dataSize
== 0)
12339 int bufSize
= 100000;
12340 if (int(2*m_dataSize
) < bufSize
)
12341 bufSize
= 2*m_dataSize
;
12342 char* buf
= new char[bufSize
+1];
12344 int left
= m_dataSize
;
12349 if (left
*2 > bufSize
)
12351 n
= bufSize
; left
-= (bufSize
/2);
12355 n
= left
*2; left
= 0;
12359 for (i
= 0; i
< (n
/2); i
++)
12361 wxDecToHex(m_data
[j
], b
, b
+1);
12366 stream
.Write((const char*) buf
, n
);
12372 // Read data in hex from a stream
12373 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::ReadHex(wxInputStream
& stream
, int length
, wxBitmapType imageType
)
12375 int dataSize
= length
/2;
12380 // create a null terminated temporary string:
12384 m_data
= new unsigned char[dataSize
];
12386 for (i
= 0; i
< dataSize
; i
++)
12388 str
[0] = (char)stream
.GetC();
12389 str
[1] = (char)stream
.GetC();
12391 m_data
[i
] = (unsigned char)wxHexToDec(str
);
12394 m_dataSize
= dataSize
;
12395 m_imageType
= imageType
;
12400 // Allocate and read from stream as a block of memory
12401 unsigned char* wxRichTextImageBlock::ReadBlock(wxInputStream
& stream
, size_t size
)
12403 unsigned char* block
= new unsigned char[size
];
12407 stream
.Read(block
, size
);
12412 unsigned char* wxRichTextImageBlock::ReadBlock(const wxString
& filename
, size_t size
)
12414 wxFileInputStream
stream(filename
);
12415 if (!stream
.IsOk())
12418 return ReadBlock(stream
, size
);
12421 // Write memory block to stream
12422 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::WriteBlock(wxOutputStream
& stream
, unsigned char* block
, size_t size
)
12424 stream
.Write((void*) block
, size
);
12425 return stream
.IsOk();
12429 // Write memory block to file
12430 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::WriteBlock(const wxString
& filename
, unsigned char* block
, size_t size
)
12432 wxFileOutputStream
outStream(filename
);
12433 if (!outStream
.IsOk())
12436 return WriteBlock(outStream
, block
, size
);
12439 // Gets the extension for the block's type
12440 wxString
wxRichTextImageBlock::GetExtension() const
12442 wxImageHandler
* handler
= wxImage::FindHandler(GetImageType());
12444 return handler
->GetExtension();
12446 return wxEmptyString
;
12452 * The data object for a wxRichTextBuffer
12455 const wxChar
*wxRichTextBufferDataObject::ms_richTextBufferFormatId
= wxT("wxRichText");
12457 wxRichTextBufferDataObject::wxRichTextBufferDataObject(wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuffer
)
12459 m_richTextBuffer
= richTextBuffer
;
12461 // this string should uniquely identify our format, but is otherwise
12463 m_formatRichTextBuffer
.SetId(GetRichTextBufferFormatId());
12465 SetFormat(m_formatRichTextBuffer
);
12468 wxRichTextBufferDataObject::~wxRichTextBufferDataObject()
12470 delete m_richTextBuffer
;
12473 // after a call to this function, the richTextBuffer is owned by the caller and it
12474 // is responsible for deleting it!
12475 wxRichTextBuffer
* wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetRichTextBuffer()
12477 wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuffer
= m_richTextBuffer
;
12478 m_richTextBuffer
= NULL
;
12480 return richTextBuffer
;
12483 wxDataFormat
wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetPreferredFormat(Direction
WXUNUSED(dir
)) const
12485 return m_formatRichTextBuffer
;
12488 size_t wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetDataSize() const
12490 if (!m_richTextBuffer
)
12496 wxStringOutputStream
stream(& bufXML
);
12497 if (!m_richTextBuffer
->SaveFile(stream
, wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
12499 wxLogError(wxT("Could not write the buffer to an XML stream.\nYou may have forgotten to add the XML file handler."));
12505 wxCharBuffer buffer
= bufXML
.mb_str(wxConvUTF8
);
12506 return strlen(buffer
) + 1;
12508 return bufXML
.Length()+1;
12512 bool wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetDataHere(void *pBuf
) const
12514 if (!pBuf
|| !m_richTextBuffer
)
12520 wxStringOutputStream
stream(& bufXML
);
12521 if (!m_richTextBuffer
->SaveFile(stream
, wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
12523 wxLogError(wxT("Could not write the buffer to an XML stream.\nYou may have forgotten to add the XML file handler."));
12529 wxCharBuffer buffer
= bufXML
.mb_str(wxConvUTF8
);
12530 size_t len
= strlen(buffer
);
12531 memcpy((char*) pBuf
, (const char*) buffer
, len
);
12532 ((char*) pBuf
)[len
] = 0;
12534 size_t len
= bufXML
.Length();
12535 memcpy((char*) pBuf
, (const char*) bufXML
.c_str(), len
);
12536 ((char*) pBuf
)[len
] = 0;
12542 bool wxRichTextBufferDataObject::SetData(size_t WXUNUSED(len
), const void *buf
)
12544 wxDELETE(m_richTextBuffer
);
12546 wxString
bufXML((const char*) buf
, wxConvUTF8
);
12548 m_richTextBuffer
= new wxRichTextBuffer
;
12550 wxStringInputStream
stream(bufXML
);
12551 if (!m_richTextBuffer
->LoadFile(stream
, wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
12553 wxLogError(wxT("Could not read the buffer from an XML stream.\nYou may have forgotten to add the XML file handler."));
12555 wxDELETE(m_richTextBuffer
);
12567 * wxRichTextFontTable
12568 * Manages quick access to a pool of fonts for rendering rich text
12571 WX_DECLARE_STRING_HASH_MAP_WITH_DECL(wxFont
, wxRichTextFontTableHashMap
, class WXDLLIMPEXP_RICHTEXT
);
12573 class wxRichTextFontTableData
: public wxObjectRefData
12576 wxRichTextFontTableData() {}
12578 wxFont
FindFont(const wxRichTextAttr
& fontSpec
, double fontScale
);
12580 wxRichTextFontTableHashMap m_hashMap
;
12583 wxFont
wxRichTextFontTableData::FindFont(const wxRichTextAttr
& fontSpec
, double fontScale
)
12585 wxString
facename(fontSpec
.GetFontFaceName());
12587 int fontSize
= fontSpec
.GetFontSize();
12588 if (fontScale
!= 1.0)
12589 fontSize
= (int) ((double(fontSize
) * fontScale
) + 0.5);
12592 if (fontSpec
.HasFontPixelSize() && !fontSpec
.HasFontPointSize())
12596 wxString spec
= wxString::Format(wxT("%d-%s-%d-%d-%d-%d-%s-%d"),
12597 fontSize
, units
.c_str(), fontSpec
.GetFontStyle(), fontSpec
.GetFontWeight(), (int) fontSpec
.GetFontUnderlined(), (int) fontSpec
.GetFontStrikethrough(),
12598 facename
.c_str(), (int) fontSpec
.GetFontEncoding());
12600 wxRichTextFontTableHashMap::iterator entry
= m_hashMap
.find(spec
);
12601 if ( entry
== m_hashMap
.end() )
12603 if (fontSpec
.HasFontPixelSize() && !fontSpec
.HasFontPointSize())
12605 wxFont
font(wxSize(0, fontSize
), wxFONTFAMILY_DEFAULT
, fontSpec
.GetFontStyle(), fontSpec
.GetFontWeight(), fontSpec
.GetFontUnderlined(), facename
);
12606 if (fontSpec
.HasFontStrikethrough() && fontSpec
.GetFontStrikethrough())
12607 font
.SetStrikethrough(true);
12608 m_hashMap
[spec
] = font
;
12613 wxFont
font(fontSize
, wxFONTFAMILY_DEFAULT
, fontSpec
.GetFontStyle(), fontSpec
.GetFontWeight(), fontSpec
.GetFontUnderlined(), facename
.c_str());
12614 if (fontSpec
.HasFontStrikethrough() && fontSpec
.GetFontStrikethrough())
12615 font
.SetStrikethrough(true);
12617 m_hashMap
[spec
] = font
;
12623 return entry
->second
;
12627 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextFontTable
, wxObject
)
12629 wxRichTextFontTable::wxRichTextFontTable()
12631 m_refData
= new wxRichTextFontTableData
;
12635 wxRichTextFontTable::wxRichTextFontTable(const wxRichTextFontTable
& table
)
12641 wxRichTextFontTable::~wxRichTextFontTable()
12646 bool wxRichTextFontTable::operator == (const wxRichTextFontTable
& table
) const
12648 return (m_refData
== table
.m_refData
);
12651 void wxRichTextFontTable::operator= (const wxRichTextFontTable
& table
)
12654 m_fontScale
= table
.m_fontScale
;
12657 wxFont
wxRichTextFontTable::FindFont(const wxRichTextAttr
& fontSpec
)
12659 wxRichTextFontTableData
* data
= (wxRichTextFontTableData
*) m_refData
;
12661 return data
->FindFont(fontSpec
, m_fontScale
);
12666 void wxRichTextFontTable::Clear()
12668 wxRichTextFontTableData
* data
= (wxRichTextFontTableData
*) m_refData
;
12670 data
->m_hashMap
.clear();
12673 void wxRichTextFontTable::SetFontScale(double fontScale
)
12675 if (fontScale
!= m_fontScale
)
12677 m_fontScale
= fontScale
;
12682 void wxTextBoxAttr::Reset()
12685 m_floatMode
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_NONE
;
12686 m_clearMode
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR_NONE
;
12687 m_collapseMode
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_NONE
;
12688 m_verticalAlignment
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_NONE
;
12689 m_boxStyleName
= wxEmptyString
;
12693 m_position
.Reset();
12704 bool wxTextBoxAttr::operator== (const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
) const
12707 m_flags
== attr
.m_flags
&&
12708 m_floatMode
== attr
.m_floatMode
&&
12709 m_clearMode
== attr
.m_clearMode
&&
12710 m_collapseMode
== attr
.m_collapseMode
&&
12711 m_verticalAlignment
== attr
.m_verticalAlignment
&&
12713 m_margins
== attr
.m_margins
&&
12714 m_padding
== attr
.m_padding
&&
12715 m_position
== attr
.m_position
&&
12717 m_size
== attr
.m_size
&&
12718 m_minSize
== attr
.m_minSize
&&
12719 m_maxSize
== attr
.m_maxSize
&&
12721 m_border
== attr
.m_border
&&
12722 m_outline
== attr
.m_outline
&&
12724 m_boxStyleName
== attr
.m_boxStyleName
12728 // Partial equality test
12729 bool wxTextBoxAttr::EqPartial(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
, bool weakTest
) const
12732 ((!HasFloatMode() && attr
.HasFloatMode()) ||
12733 (!HasClearMode() && attr
.HasClearMode()) ||
12734 (!HasCollapseBorders() && attr
.HasCollapseBorders()) ||
12735 (!HasVerticalAlignment() && attr
.HasVerticalAlignment()) ||
12736 (!HasBoxStyleName() && attr
.HasBoxStyleName())))
12740 if (attr
.HasFloatMode() && HasFloatMode() && (GetFloatMode() != attr
.GetFloatMode()))
12743 if (attr
.HasClearMode() && HasClearMode() && (GetClearMode() != attr
.GetClearMode()))
12746 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders() && HasCollapseBorders() && (attr
.GetCollapseBorders() != GetCollapseBorders()))
12749 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment() && HasVerticalAlignment() && (attr
.GetVerticalAlignment() != GetVerticalAlignment()))
12752 if (attr
.HasBoxStyleName() && HasBoxStyleName() && (attr
.GetBoxStyleName() != GetBoxStyleName()))
12757 if (!m_position
.EqPartial(attr
.m_position
, weakTest
))
12762 if (!m_size
.EqPartial(attr
.m_size
, weakTest
))
12764 if (!m_minSize
.EqPartial(attr
.m_minSize
, weakTest
))
12766 if (!m_maxSize
.EqPartial(attr
.m_maxSize
, weakTest
))
12771 if (!m_margins
.EqPartial(attr
.m_margins
, weakTest
))
12776 if (!m_padding
.EqPartial(attr
.m_padding
, weakTest
))
12781 if (!GetBorder().EqPartial(attr
.GetBorder(), weakTest
))
12786 if (!GetOutline().EqPartial(attr
.GetOutline(), weakTest
))
12792 // Merges the given attributes. If compareWith
12793 // is non-NULL, then it will be used to mask out those attributes that are the same in style
12794 // and compareWith, for situations where we don't want to explicitly set inherited attributes.
12795 bool wxTextBoxAttr::Apply(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
, const wxTextBoxAttr
* compareWith
)
12797 if (attr
.HasFloatMode())
12799 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasFloatMode() && compareWith
->GetFloatMode() == attr
.GetFloatMode()))
12800 SetFloatMode(attr
.GetFloatMode());
12803 if (attr
.HasClearMode())
12805 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasClearMode() && compareWith
->GetClearMode() == attr
.GetClearMode()))
12806 SetClearMode(attr
.GetClearMode());
12809 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders())
12811 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasCollapseBorders() && compareWith
->GetCollapseBorders() == attr
.GetCollapseBorders()))
12812 SetCollapseBorders(attr
.GetCollapseBorders());
12815 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
12817 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasVerticalAlignment() && compareWith
->GetVerticalAlignment() == attr
.GetVerticalAlignment()))
12818 SetVerticalAlignment(attr
.GetVerticalAlignment());
12821 if (attr
.HasBoxStyleName())
12823 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasBoxStyleName() && compareWith
->GetBoxStyleName() == attr
.GetBoxStyleName()))
12824 SetBoxStyleName(attr
.GetBoxStyleName());
12827 m_margins
.Apply(attr
.m_margins
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_margins
) : (const wxTextAttrDimensions
*) NULL
);
12828 m_padding
.Apply(attr
.m_padding
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_padding
) : (const wxTextAttrDimensions
*) NULL
);
12829 m_position
.Apply(attr
.m_position
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_position
) : (const wxTextAttrDimensions
*) NULL
);
12831 m_size
.Apply(attr
.m_size
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_size
) : (const wxTextAttrSize
*) NULL
);
12832 m_minSize
.Apply(attr
.m_minSize
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_minSize
) : (const wxTextAttrSize
*) NULL
);
12833 m_maxSize
.Apply(attr
.m_maxSize
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_maxSize
) : (const wxTextAttrSize
*) NULL
);
12835 m_border
.Apply(attr
.m_border
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_border
) : (const wxTextAttrBorders
*) NULL
);
12836 m_outline
.Apply(attr
.m_outline
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_outline
) : (const wxTextAttrBorders
*) NULL
);
12841 // Remove specified attributes from this object
12842 bool wxTextBoxAttr::RemoveStyle(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
)
12844 if (attr
.HasFloatMode())
12845 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
12847 if (attr
.HasClearMode())
12848 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
12850 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders())
12851 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
12853 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
12854 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
12856 if (attr
.HasBoxStyleName())
12858 SetBoxStyleName(wxEmptyString
);
12859 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BOX_STYLE_NAME
);
12862 m_margins
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_margins
);
12863 m_padding
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_padding
);
12864 m_position
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_position
);
12866 m_size
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_size
);
12867 m_minSize
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_minSize
);
12868 m_maxSize
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_maxSize
);
12870 m_border
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_border
);
12871 m_outline
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_outline
);
12876 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
12877 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
12878 void wxTextBoxAttr::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
, wxTextBoxAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxTextBoxAttr
& absentAttr
)
12880 if (attr
.HasFloatMode())
12882 if (!clashingAttr
.HasFloatMode() && !absentAttr
.HasFloatMode())
12884 if (HasFloatMode())
12886 if (GetFloatMode() != attr
.GetFloatMode())
12888 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
12889 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
12893 SetFloatMode(attr
.GetFloatMode());
12897 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
12899 if (attr
.HasClearMode())
12901 if (!clashingAttr
.HasClearMode() && !absentAttr
.HasClearMode())
12903 if (HasClearMode())
12905 if (GetClearMode() != attr
.GetClearMode())
12907 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
12908 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
12912 SetClearMode(attr
.GetClearMode());
12916 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
12918 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders())
12920 if (!clashingAttr
.HasCollapseBorders() && !absentAttr
.HasCollapseBorders())
12922 if (HasCollapseBorders())
12924 if (GetCollapseBorders() != attr
.GetCollapseBorders())
12926 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
12927 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
12931 SetCollapseBorders(attr
.GetCollapseBorders());
12935 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
12937 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
12939 if (!clashingAttr
.HasVerticalAlignment() && !absentAttr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
12941 if (HasVerticalAlignment())
12943 if (GetVerticalAlignment() != attr
.GetVerticalAlignment())
12945 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
12946 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
12950 SetVerticalAlignment(attr
.GetVerticalAlignment());
12954 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
12956 if (attr
.HasBoxStyleName())
12958 if (!clashingAttr
.HasBoxStyleName() && !absentAttr
.HasBoxStyleName())
12960 if (HasBoxStyleName())
12962 if (GetBoxStyleName() != attr
.GetBoxStyleName())
12964 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BOX_STYLE_NAME
);
12965 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BOX_STYLE_NAME
);
12969 SetBoxStyleName(attr
.GetBoxStyleName());
12973 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BOX_STYLE_NAME
);
12975 m_margins
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_margins
, clashingAttr
.m_margins
, absentAttr
.m_margins
);
12976 m_padding
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_padding
, clashingAttr
.m_padding
, absentAttr
.m_padding
);
12977 m_position
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_position
, clashingAttr
.m_position
, absentAttr
.m_position
);
12979 m_size
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_size
, clashingAttr
.m_size
, absentAttr
.m_size
);
12980 m_minSize
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_minSize
, clashingAttr
.m_minSize
, absentAttr
.m_minSize
);
12981 m_maxSize
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_maxSize
, clashingAttr
.m_maxSize
, absentAttr
.m_maxSize
);
12983 m_border
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_border
, clashingAttr
.m_border
, absentAttr
.m_border
);
12984 m_outline
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_outline
, clashingAttr
.m_outline
, absentAttr
.m_outline
);
12987 bool wxTextBoxAttr::IsDefault() const
12989 return GetFlags() == 0 && !m_border
.IsValid() && !m_outline
.IsValid() &&
12990 !m_size
.IsValid() && !m_minSize
.IsValid() && !m_maxSize
.IsValid() &&
12991 !m_position
.IsValid() && !m_padding
.IsValid() && !m_margins
.IsValid();
12996 void wxRichTextAttr::Copy(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
12998 wxTextAttr::Copy(attr
);
13000 m_textBoxAttr
= attr
.m_textBoxAttr
;
13003 bool wxRichTextAttr::operator==(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
) const
13005 if (!(wxTextAttr::operator==(attr
)))
13008 return (m_textBoxAttr
== attr
.m_textBoxAttr
);
13011 // Partial equality test
13012 bool wxRichTextAttr::EqPartial(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, bool weakTest
) const
13014 if (!(wxTextAttr::EqPartial(attr
, weakTest
)))
13017 return m_textBoxAttr
.EqPartial(attr
.m_textBoxAttr
, weakTest
);
13020 // Merges the given attributes. If compareWith
13021 // is non-NULL, then it will be used to mask out those attributes that are the same in style
13022 // and compareWith, for situations where we don't want to explicitly set inherited attributes.
13023 bool wxRichTextAttr::Apply(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, const wxRichTextAttr
* compareWith
)
13025 wxTextAttr::Apply(style
, compareWith
);
13027 return m_textBoxAttr
.Apply(style
.m_textBoxAttr
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_textBoxAttr
) : (const wxTextBoxAttr
*) NULL
);
13030 // Remove specified attributes from this object
13031 bool wxRichTextAttr::RemoveStyle(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
13033 wxTextAttr::RemoveStyle(*this, attr
);
13035 return m_textBoxAttr
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_textBoxAttr
);
13038 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
13039 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
13040 void wxRichTextAttr::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, wxRichTextAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxRichTextAttr
& absentAttr
)
13042 wxTextAttrCollectCommonAttributes(*this, attr
, clashingAttr
, absentAttr
);
13044 m_textBoxAttr
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_textBoxAttr
, clashingAttr
.m_textBoxAttr
, absentAttr
.m_textBoxAttr
);
13047 // Partial equality test
13048 bool wxTextAttrBorder::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrBorder
& border
, bool weakTest
) const
13051 ((!HasStyle() && border
.HasStyle()) ||
13052 (!HasColour() && border
.HasColour()) ||
13053 (!HasWidth() && border
.HasWidth())))
13058 if (border
.HasStyle() && HasStyle() && (border
.GetStyle() != GetStyle()))
13061 if (border
.HasColour() && HasColour() && (border
.GetColourLong() != GetColourLong()))
13064 if (border
.HasWidth() && HasWidth() && !(border
.GetWidth() == GetWidth()))
13070 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
13071 bool wxTextAttrBorder::Apply(const wxTextAttrBorder
& border
, const wxTextAttrBorder
* compareWith
)
13073 if (border
.HasStyle())
13075 if (!(compareWith
&& (border
.GetStyle() == compareWith
->GetStyle())))
13076 SetStyle(border
.GetStyle());
13078 if (border
.HasColour())
13080 if (!(compareWith
&& (border
.GetColourLong() == compareWith
->GetColourLong())))
13081 SetColour(border
.GetColourLong());
13083 if (border
.HasWidth())
13085 if (!(compareWith
&& (border
.GetWidth() == compareWith
->GetWidth())))
13086 SetWidth(border
.GetWidth());
13092 // Remove specified attributes from this object
13093 bool wxTextAttrBorder::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrBorder
& attr
)
13095 if (attr
.HasStyle() && HasStyle())
13096 SetFlags(GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
13097 if (attr
.HasColour() && HasColour())
13098 SetFlags(GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
13099 if (attr
.HasWidth() && HasWidth())
13100 m_borderWidth
.Reset();
13105 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
13106 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
13107 void wxTextAttrBorder::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrBorder
& attr
, wxTextAttrBorder
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrBorder
& absentAttr
)
13109 if (attr
.HasStyle())
13111 if (!clashingAttr
.HasStyle() && !absentAttr
.HasStyle())
13115 if (GetStyle() != attr
.GetStyle())
13117 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
13118 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
13122 SetStyle(attr
.GetStyle());
13126 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
13128 if (attr
.HasColour())
13130 if (!clashingAttr
.HasColour() && !absentAttr
.HasColour())
13134 if (GetColour() != attr
.GetColour())
13136 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
13137 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
13141 SetColour(attr
.GetColourLong());
13145 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
13147 m_borderWidth
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_borderWidth
, clashingAttr
.m_borderWidth
, absentAttr
.m_borderWidth
);
13150 // Partial equality test
13151 bool wxTextAttrBorders::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrBorders
& borders
, bool weakTest
) const
13153 return m_left
.EqPartial(borders
.m_left
, weakTest
) && m_right
.EqPartial(borders
.m_right
, weakTest
) &&
13154 m_top
.EqPartial(borders
.m_top
, weakTest
) && m_bottom
.EqPartial(borders
.m_bottom
, weakTest
);
13157 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
13158 bool wxTextAttrBorders::Apply(const wxTextAttrBorders
& borders
, const wxTextAttrBorders
* compareWith
)
13160 m_left
.Apply(borders
.m_left
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_left
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
13161 m_right
.Apply(borders
.m_right
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_right
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
13162 m_top
.Apply(borders
.m_top
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_top
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
13163 m_bottom
.Apply(borders
.m_bottom
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_bottom
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
13167 // Remove specified attributes from this object
13168 bool wxTextAttrBorders::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrBorders
& attr
)
13170 m_left
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_left
);
13171 m_right
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_right
);
13172 m_top
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_top
);
13173 m_bottom
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_bottom
);
13177 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
13178 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
13179 void wxTextAttrBorders::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrBorders
& attr
, wxTextAttrBorders
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrBorders
& absentAttr
)
13181 m_left
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_left
, clashingAttr
.m_left
, absentAttr
.m_left
);
13182 m_right
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_right
, clashingAttr
.m_right
, absentAttr
.m_right
);
13183 m_top
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_top
, clashingAttr
.m_top
, absentAttr
.m_top
);
13184 m_bottom
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_bottom
, clashingAttr
.m_bottom
, absentAttr
.m_bottom
);
13187 // Set style of all borders
13188 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetStyle(int style
)
13190 m_left
.SetStyle(style
);
13191 m_right
.SetStyle(style
);
13192 m_top
.SetStyle(style
);
13193 m_bottom
.SetStyle(style
);
13196 // Set colour of all borders
13197 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetColour(unsigned long colour
)
13199 m_left
.SetColour(colour
);
13200 m_right
.SetColour(colour
);
13201 m_top
.SetColour(colour
);
13202 m_bottom
.SetColour(colour
);
13205 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetColour(const wxColour
& colour
)
13207 m_left
.SetColour(colour
);
13208 m_right
.SetColour(colour
);
13209 m_top
.SetColour(colour
);
13210 m_bottom
.SetColour(colour
);
13213 // Set width of all borders
13214 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetWidth(const wxTextAttrDimension
& width
)
13216 m_left
.SetWidth(width
);
13217 m_right
.SetWidth(width
);
13218 m_top
.SetWidth(width
);
13219 m_bottom
.SetWidth(width
);
13222 // Partial equality test
13223 bool wxTextAttrDimension::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
, bool weakTest
) const
13225 if (!weakTest
&& !IsValid() && dim
.IsValid())
13228 if (dim
.IsValid() && IsValid() && !((*this) == dim
))
13234 bool wxTextAttrDimension::Apply(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
, const wxTextAttrDimension
* compareWith
)
13238 if (!(compareWith
&& dim
== (*compareWith
)))
13245 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
13246 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
13247 void wxTextAttrDimension::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrDimension
& attr
, wxTextAttrDimension
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrDimension
& absentAttr
)
13249 if (attr
.IsValid())
13251 if (!clashingAttr
.IsValid() && !absentAttr
.IsValid())
13255 if (!((*this) == attr
))
13257 clashingAttr
.SetValid(true);
13266 absentAttr
.SetValid(true);
13269 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::wxTextAttrDimensionConverter(wxDC
& dc
, double scale
, const wxSize
& parentSize
)
13271 m_ppi
= dc
.GetPPI().x
; m_scale
= scale
; m_parentSize
= parentSize
;
13274 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::wxTextAttrDimensionConverter(int ppi
, double scale
, const wxSize
& parentSize
)
13276 m_ppi
= ppi
; m_scale
= scale
; m_parentSize
= parentSize
;
13279 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(int units
) const
13281 return wxRichTextObject::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(m_ppi
, units
, m_scale
);
13284 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(int pixels
) const
13286 return wxRichTextObject::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(m_ppi
, pixels
, m_scale
);
13289 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::GetPixels(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
, int direction
) const
13291 if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
13292 return ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dim
.GetValue());
13293 else if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
13294 return dim
.GetValue();
13295 else if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
13297 wxASSERT(m_parentSize
!= wxDefaultSize
);
13298 if (direction
== wxHORIZONTAL
)
13299 return (int) (double(m_parentSize
.x
) * double(dim
.GetValue()) / 100.0);
13301 return (int) (double(m_parentSize
.y
) * double(dim
.GetValue()) / 100.0);
13310 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::GetTenthsMM(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
) const
13312 if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
13313 return dim
.GetValue();
13314 else if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
13315 return ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(dim
.GetValue());
13323 // Partial equality test
13324 bool wxTextAttrDimensions::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& dims
, bool weakTest
) const
13326 if (!m_left
.EqPartial(dims
.m_left
, weakTest
))
13329 if (!m_right
.EqPartial(dims
.m_right
, weakTest
))
13332 if (!m_top
.EqPartial(dims
.m_top
, weakTest
))
13335 if (!m_bottom
.EqPartial(dims
.m_bottom
, weakTest
))
13341 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
13342 bool wxTextAttrDimensions::Apply(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& dims
, const wxTextAttrDimensions
* compareWith
)
13344 m_left
.Apply(dims
.m_left
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_left
) : (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
13345 m_right
.Apply(dims
.m_right
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_right
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
13346 m_top
.Apply(dims
.m_top
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_top
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
13347 m_bottom
.Apply(dims
.m_bottom
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_bottom
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
13352 // Remove specified attributes from this object
13353 bool wxTextAttrDimensions::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& attr
)
13355 if (attr
.m_left
.IsValid())
13357 if (attr
.m_right
.IsValid())
13359 if (attr
.m_top
.IsValid())
13361 if (attr
.m_bottom
.IsValid())
13367 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
13368 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
13369 void wxTextAttrDimensions::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& attr
, wxTextAttrDimensions
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrDimensions
& absentAttr
)
13371 m_left
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_left
, clashingAttr
.m_left
, absentAttr
.m_left
);
13372 m_right
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_right
, clashingAttr
.m_right
, absentAttr
.m_right
);
13373 m_top
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_top
, clashingAttr
.m_top
, absentAttr
.m_top
);
13374 m_bottom
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_bottom
, clashingAttr
.m_bottom
, absentAttr
.m_bottom
);
13377 // Partial equality test
13378 bool wxTextAttrSize::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrSize
& size
, bool weakTest
) const
13380 if (!m_width
.EqPartial(size
.m_width
, weakTest
))
13383 if (!m_height
.EqPartial(size
.m_height
, weakTest
))
13389 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
13390 bool wxTextAttrSize::Apply(const wxTextAttrSize
& size
, const wxTextAttrSize
* compareWith
)
13392 m_width
.Apply(size
.m_width
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_width
) : (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
13393 m_height
.Apply(size
.m_height
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_height
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
13398 // Remove specified attributes from this object
13399 bool wxTextAttrSize::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrSize
& attr
)
13401 if (attr
.m_width
.IsValid())
13403 if (attr
.m_height
.IsValid())
13409 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
13410 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
13411 void wxTextAttrSize::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrSize
& attr
, wxTextAttrSize
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrSize
& absentAttr
)
13413 m_width
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_width
, clashingAttr
.m_width
, absentAttr
.m_width
);
13414 m_height
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_height
, clashingAttr
.m_height
, absentAttr
.m_height
);
13417 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
13418 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
13419 void wxTextAttrCollectCommonAttributes(wxTextAttr
& currentStyle
, const wxTextAttr
& attr
, wxTextAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttr
& absentAttr
)
13421 absentAttr
.SetFlags(absentAttr
.GetFlags() | (~attr
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_ALL
));
13422 absentAttr
.SetTextEffectFlags(absentAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags() | (~attr
.GetTextEffectFlags() & 0xFFFF));
13424 long forbiddenFlags
= clashingAttr
.GetFlags()|absentAttr
.GetFlags();
13426 // If different font size units are being used, this is a clash.
13427 if (((attr
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
) | (currentStyle
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
)) == wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
)
13429 currentStyle
.SetFontSize(0);
13430 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
);
13431 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
);
13435 if (attr
.HasFontPointSize() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_POINT_SIZE
))
13437 if (currentStyle
.HasFontPointSize())
13439 if (currentStyle
.GetFontSize() != attr
.GetFontSize())
13441 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13442 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_POINT_SIZE
);
13443 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_POINT_SIZE
);
13447 currentStyle
.SetFontSize(attr
.GetFontSize());
13449 else if (!attr
.HasFontPointSize() && currentStyle
.HasFontPointSize())
13451 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_POINT_SIZE
);
13452 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_POINT_SIZE
);
13455 if (attr
.HasFontPixelSize() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_PIXEL_SIZE
))
13457 if (currentStyle
.HasFontPixelSize())
13459 if (currentStyle
.GetFontSize() != attr
.GetFontSize())
13461 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13462 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_PIXEL_SIZE
);
13463 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_PIXEL_SIZE
);
13467 currentStyle
.SetFontPixelSize(attr
.GetFontSize());
13469 else if (!attr
.HasFontPixelSize() && currentStyle
.HasFontPixelSize())
13471 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_PIXEL_SIZE
);
13472 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_PIXEL_SIZE
);
13476 if (attr
.HasFontItalic() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
))
13478 if (currentStyle
.HasFontItalic())
13480 if (currentStyle
.GetFontStyle() != attr
.GetFontStyle())
13482 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13483 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
);
13484 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
);
13488 currentStyle
.SetFontStyle(attr
.GetFontStyle());
13490 else if (!attr
.HasFontItalic() && currentStyle
.HasFontItalic())
13492 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
);
13493 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
);
13496 if (attr
.HasFontFamily() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
))
13498 if (currentStyle
.HasFontFamily())
13500 if (currentStyle
.GetFontFamily() != attr
.GetFontFamily())
13502 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13503 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
);
13504 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
);
13508 currentStyle
.SetFontFamily(attr
.GetFontFamily());
13510 else if (!attr
.HasFontFamily() && currentStyle
.HasFontFamily())
13512 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
);
13513 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
);
13516 if (attr
.HasFontWeight() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
))
13518 if (currentStyle
.HasFontWeight())
13520 if (currentStyle
.GetFontWeight() != attr
.GetFontWeight())
13522 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13523 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
);
13524 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
);
13528 currentStyle
.SetFontWeight(attr
.GetFontWeight());
13530 else if (!attr
.HasFontWeight() && currentStyle
.HasFontWeight())
13532 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
);
13533 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
);
13536 if (attr
.HasFontFaceName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
))
13538 if (currentStyle
.HasFontFaceName())
13540 wxString
faceName1(currentStyle
.GetFontFaceName());
13541 wxString
faceName2(attr
.GetFontFaceName());
13543 if (faceName1
!= faceName2
)
13545 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13546 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
);
13547 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
);
13551 currentStyle
.SetFontFaceName(attr
.GetFontFaceName());
13553 else if (!attr
.HasFontFaceName() && currentStyle
.HasFontFaceName())
13555 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
);
13556 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
);
13559 if (attr
.HasFontUnderlined() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
))
13561 if (currentStyle
.HasFontUnderlined())
13563 if (currentStyle
.GetFontUnderlined() != attr
.GetFontUnderlined())
13565 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13566 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
);
13567 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
);
13571 currentStyle
.SetFontUnderlined(attr
.GetFontUnderlined());
13573 else if (!attr
.HasFontUnderlined() && currentStyle
.HasFontUnderlined())
13575 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
);
13576 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
);
13579 if (attr
.HasFontStrikethrough() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_STRIKETHROUGH
))
13581 if (currentStyle
.HasFontStrikethrough())
13583 if (currentStyle
.GetFontStrikethrough() != attr
.GetFontStrikethrough())
13585 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13586 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_STRIKETHROUGH
);
13587 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_STRIKETHROUGH
);
13591 currentStyle
.SetFontStrikethrough(attr
.GetFontStrikethrough());
13593 else if (!attr
.HasFontStrikethrough() && currentStyle
.HasFontStrikethrough())
13595 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_STRIKETHROUGH
);
13596 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_STRIKETHROUGH
);
13599 if (attr
.HasTextColour() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
))
13601 if (currentStyle
.HasTextColour())
13603 if (currentStyle
.GetTextColour() != attr
.GetTextColour())
13605 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13606 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
13607 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
13611 currentStyle
.SetTextColour(attr
.GetTextColour());
13613 else if (!attr
.HasTextColour() && currentStyle
.HasTextColour())
13615 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
13616 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
13619 if (attr
.HasBackgroundColour() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
))
13621 if (currentStyle
.HasBackgroundColour())
13623 if (currentStyle
.GetBackgroundColour() != attr
.GetBackgroundColour())
13625 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13626 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
13627 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
13631 currentStyle
.SetBackgroundColour(attr
.GetBackgroundColour());
13633 else if (!attr
.HasBackgroundColour() && currentStyle
.HasBackgroundColour())
13635 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
13636 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
13639 if (attr
.HasAlignment() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
))
13641 if (currentStyle
.HasAlignment())
13643 if (currentStyle
.GetAlignment() != attr
.GetAlignment())
13645 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13646 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
13647 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
13651 currentStyle
.SetAlignment(attr
.GetAlignment());
13653 else if (!attr
.HasAlignment() && currentStyle
.HasAlignment())
13655 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
13656 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
13659 if (attr
.HasTabs() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
))
13661 if (currentStyle
.HasTabs())
13663 if (!wxRichTextTabsEq(currentStyle
.GetTabs(), attr
.GetTabs()))
13665 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13666 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
);
13667 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
);
13671 currentStyle
.SetTabs(attr
.GetTabs());
13673 else if (!attr
.HasTabs() && currentStyle
.HasTabs())
13675 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
);
13676 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
);
13679 if (attr
.HasLeftIndent() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
))
13681 if (currentStyle
.HasLeftIndent())
13683 if (currentStyle
.GetLeftIndent() != attr
.GetLeftIndent() || currentStyle
.GetLeftSubIndent() != attr
.GetLeftSubIndent())
13685 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13686 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
13687 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
13691 currentStyle
.SetLeftIndent(attr
.GetLeftIndent(), attr
.GetLeftSubIndent());
13693 else if (!attr
.HasLeftIndent() && currentStyle
.HasLeftIndent())
13695 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
13696 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
13699 if (attr
.HasRightIndent() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
))
13701 if (currentStyle
.HasRightIndent())
13703 if (currentStyle
.GetRightIndent() != attr
.GetRightIndent())
13705 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13706 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
13707 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
13711 currentStyle
.SetRightIndent(attr
.GetRightIndent());
13713 else if (!attr
.HasRightIndent() && currentStyle
.HasRightIndent())
13715 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
13716 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
13719 if (attr
.HasParagraphSpacingAfter() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
))
13721 if (currentStyle
.HasParagraphSpacingAfter())
13723 if (currentStyle
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter() != attr
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter())
13725 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13726 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
);
13727 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
);
13731 currentStyle
.SetParagraphSpacingAfter(attr
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter());
13733 else if (!attr
.HasParagraphSpacingAfter() && currentStyle
.HasParagraphSpacingAfter())
13735 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
);
13736 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
);
13739 if (attr
.HasParagraphSpacingBefore() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
))
13741 if (currentStyle
.HasParagraphSpacingBefore())
13743 if (currentStyle
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore() != attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore())
13745 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13746 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
);
13747 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
);
13751 currentStyle
.SetParagraphSpacingBefore(attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore());
13753 else if (!attr
.HasParagraphSpacingBefore() && currentStyle
.HasParagraphSpacingBefore())
13755 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
);
13756 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
);
13759 if (attr
.HasLineSpacing() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
))
13761 if (currentStyle
.HasLineSpacing())
13763 if (currentStyle
.GetLineSpacing() != attr
.GetLineSpacing())
13765 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13766 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
13767 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
13771 currentStyle
.SetLineSpacing(attr
.GetLineSpacing());
13773 else if (!attr
.HasLineSpacing() && currentStyle
.HasLineSpacing())
13775 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
13776 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
13779 if (attr
.HasCharacterStyleName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
))
13781 if (currentStyle
.HasCharacterStyleName())
13783 if (currentStyle
.GetCharacterStyleName() != attr
.GetCharacterStyleName())
13785 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13786 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
);
13787 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
);
13791 currentStyle
.SetCharacterStyleName(attr
.GetCharacterStyleName());
13793 else if (!attr
.HasCharacterStyleName() && currentStyle
.HasCharacterStyleName())
13795 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
);
13796 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
);
13799 if (attr
.HasParagraphStyleName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
))
13801 if (currentStyle
.HasParagraphStyleName())
13803 if (currentStyle
.GetParagraphStyleName() != attr
.GetParagraphStyleName())
13805 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13806 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
);
13807 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
);
13811 currentStyle
.SetParagraphStyleName(attr
.GetParagraphStyleName());
13813 else if (!attr
.HasParagraphStyleName() && currentStyle
.HasParagraphStyleName())
13815 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
);
13816 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
);
13819 if (attr
.HasListStyleName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
))
13821 if (currentStyle
.HasListStyleName())
13823 if (currentStyle
.GetListStyleName() != attr
.GetListStyleName())
13825 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13826 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
13827 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
13831 currentStyle
.SetListStyleName(attr
.GetListStyleName());
13833 else if (!attr
.HasListStyleName() && currentStyle
.HasListStyleName())
13835 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
13836 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
13839 if (attr
.HasBulletStyle() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
))
13841 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletStyle())
13843 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletStyle() != attr
.GetBulletStyle())
13845 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13846 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
);
13847 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
);
13851 currentStyle
.SetBulletStyle(attr
.GetBulletStyle());
13853 else if (!attr
.HasBulletStyle() && currentStyle
.HasBulletStyle())
13855 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
);
13856 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
);
13859 if (attr
.HasBulletNumber() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
))
13861 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletNumber())
13863 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletNumber() != attr
.GetBulletNumber())
13865 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13866 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
);
13867 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
);
13871 currentStyle
.SetBulletNumber(attr
.GetBulletNumber());
13873 else if (!attr
.HasBulletNumber() && currentStyle
.HasBulletNumber())
13875 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
);
13876 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
);
13879 if (attr
.HasBulletText() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
))
13881 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletText())
13883 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletText() != attr
.GetBulletText())
13885 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13886 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
);
13887 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
);
13892 currentStyle
.SetBulletText(attr
.GetBulletText());
13893 currentStyle
.SetBulletFont(attr
.GetBulletFont());
13896 else if (!attr
.HasBulletText() && currentStyle
.HasBulletText())
13898 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
);
13899 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
);
13902 if (attr
.HasBulletName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
))
13904 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletName())
13906 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletName() != attr
.GetBulletName())
13908 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13909 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
);
13910 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
);
13915 currentStyle
.SetBulletName(attr
.GetBulletName());
13918 else if (!attr
.HasBulletName() && currentStyle
.HasBulletName())
13920 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
);
13921 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
);
13924 if (attr
.HasURL() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
))
13926 if (currentStyle
.HasURL())
13928 if (currentStyle
.GetURL() != attr
.GetURL())
13930 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13931 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
);
13932 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
);
13937 currentStyle
.SetURL(attr
.GetURL());
13940 else if (!attr
.HasURL() && currentStyle
.HasURL())
13942 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
);
13943 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
);
13946 if (attr
.HasTextEffects() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECTS
))
13948 if (currentStyle
.HasTextEffects())
13950 // We need to find the bits in the new attr that are different:
13951 // just look at those bits that are specified by the new attr.
13953 // We need to remove the bits and flags that are not common between current attr
13954 // and new attr. In so doing we need to take account of the styles absent from one or more of the
13955 // previous styles.
13957 int currentRelevantTextEffects
= currentStyle
.GetTextEffects() & attr
.GetTextEffectFlags();
13958 int newRelevantTextEffects
= attr
.GetTextEffects() & attr
.GetTextEffectFlags();
13960 if (currentRelevantTextEffects
!= newRelevantTextEffects
)
13962 // Find the text effects that were different, using XOR
13963 int differentEffects
= currentRelevantTextEffects
^ newRelevantTextEffects
;
13965 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13966 clashingAttr
.SetTextEffectFlags(clashingAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags() | differentEffects
);
13967 currentStyle
.SetTextEffectFlags(currentStyle
.GetTextEffectFlags() & ~differentEffects
);
13972 currentStyle
.SetTextEffects(attr
.GetTextEffects());
13973 currentStyle
.SetTextEffectFlags(attr
.GetTextEffectFlags());
13976 // Mask out the flags and values that cannot be common because they were absent in one or more objecrs
13977 // that we've looked at so far
13978 currentStyle
.SetTextEffects(currentStyle
.GetTextEffects() & ~absentAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags());
13979 currentStyle
.SetTextEffectFlags(currentStyle
.GetTextEffectFlags() & ~absentAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags());
13981 if (currentStyle
.GetTextEffectFlags() == 0)
13982 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECTS
);
13984 else if (!attr
.HasTextEffects() && currentStyle
.HasTextEffects())
13986 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECTS
);
13987 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECTS
);
13990 if (attr
.HasOutlineLevel() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
))
13992 if (currentStyle
.HasOutlineLevel())
13994 if (currentStyle
.GetOutlineLevel() != attr
.GetOutlineLevel())
13996 // Clash of attr - mark as such
13997 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
);
13998 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
);
14002 currentStyle
.SetOutlineLevel(attr
.GetOutlineLevel());
14004 else if (!attr
.HasOutlineLevel() && currentStyle
.HasOutlineLevel())
14006 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
);
14007 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
);
14011 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextVariantArray
);
14012 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextAttrArray
);
14013 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextRectArray
);
14015 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextProperties
, wxObject
)
14017 bool wxRichTextProperties::operator==(const wxRichTextProperties
& props
) const
14019 if (m_properties
.GetCount() != props
.GetCount())
14023 for (i
= 0; i
< m_properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
14025 const wxVariant
& var1
= m_properties
[i
];
14026 int idx
= props
.Find(var1
.GetName());
14029 const wxVariant
& var2
= props
.m_properties
[idx
];
14030 if (!(var1
== var2
))
14037 wxArrayString
wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyNames() const
14041 for (i
= 0; i
< m_properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
14043 arr
.Add(m_properties
[i
].GetName());
14048 int wxRichTextProperties::Find(const wxString
& name
) const
14051 for (i
= 0; i
< m_properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
14053 if (m_properties
[i
].GetName() == name
)
14059 bool wxRichTextProperties::Remove(const wxString
& name
)
14061 int idx
= Find(name
);
14064 m_properties
.RemoveAt(idx
);
14071 wxVariant
* wxRichTextProperties::FindOrCreateProperty(const wxString
& name
)
14073 int idx
= Find(name
);
14074 if (idx
== wxNOT_FOUND
)
14075 SetProperty(name
, wxString());
14077 if (idx
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
14079 return & (*this)[idx
];
14085 const wxVariant
& wxRichTextProperties::GetProperty(const wxString
& name
) const
14087 static const wxVariant nullVariant
;
14088 int idx
= Find(name
);
14090 return m_properties
[idx
];
14092 return nullVariant
;
14095 wxString
wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyString(const wxString
& name
) const
14097 return GetProperty(name
).GetString();
14100 long wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyLong(const wxString
& name
) const
14102 return GetProperty(name
).GetLong();
14105 bool wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyBool(const wxString
& name
) const
14107 return GetProperty(name
).GetBool();
14110 double wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyDouble(const wxString
& name
) const
14112 return GetProperty(name
).GetDouble();
14115 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxVariant
& variant
)
14117 wxASSERT(!variant
.GetName().IsEmpty());
14119 int idx
= Find(variant
.GetName());
14122 m_properties
.Add(variant
);
14124 m_properties
[idx
] = variant
;
14127 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, const wxVariant
& variant
)
14129 int idx
= Find(name
);
14130 wxVariant
var(variant
);
14134 m_properties
.Add(var
);
14136 m_properties
[idx
] = var
;
14139 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, const wxString
& value
)
14141 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
14144 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, long value
)
14146 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
14149 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, double value
)
14151 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
14154 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, bool value
)
14156 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
14159 void wxRichTextProperties::RemoveProperties(const wxRichTextProperties
& properties
)
14162 for (i
= 0; i
< properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
14164 wxString name
= properties
.GetProperties()[i
].GetName();
14165 if (HasProperty(name
))
14170 void wxRichTextProperties::MergeProperties(const wxRichTextProperties
& properties
)
14173 for (i
= 0; i
< properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
14175 SetProperty(properties
.GetProperties()[i
]);
14179 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextObjectAddress::GetObject(wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* topLevelContainer
) const
14181 if (m_address
.GetCount() == 0)
14182 return topLevelContainer
;
14184 wxRichTextCompositeObject
* p
= topLevelContainer
;
14186 while (p
&& i
< m_address
.GetCount())
14188 int pos
= m_address
[i
];
14189 wxASSERT(pos
>= 0 && pos
< (int) p
->GetChildren().GetCount());
14190 if (pos
< 0 || pos
>= (int) p
->GetChildren().GetCount())
14193 wxRichTextObject
* p1
= p
->GetChild(pos
);
14194 if (i
== (m_address
.GetCount()-1))
14197 p
= wxDynamicCast(p1
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
);
14203 bool wxRichTextObjectAddress::Create(wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* topLevelContainer
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
14207 if (topLevelContainer
== obj
)
14210 wxRichTextObject
* o
= obj
;
14213 wxRichTextCompositeObject
* p
= wxDynamicCast(o
->GetParent(), wxRichTextCompositeObject
);
14217 int pos
= p
->GetChildren().IndexOf(o
);
14221 m_address
.Insert(pos
, 0);
14223 if (p
== topLevelContainer
)
14232 bool wxRichTextSelection::operator==(const wxRichTextSelection
& sel
) const
14234 if (m_container
!= sel
.m_container
)
14236 if (m_ranges
.GetCount() != sel
.m_ranges
.GetCount())
14239 for (i
= 0; i
< m_ranges
.GetCount(); i
++)
14240 if (!(m_ranges
[i
] == sel
.m_ranges
[i
]))
14245 // Get the selections appropriate to the specified object, if any; returns wxRICHTEXT_NO_SELECTION if none
14246 // or none at the level of the object's container.
14247 wxRichTextRangeArray
wxRichTextSelection::GetSelectionForObject(wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
14251 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= obj
->GetParentContainer();
14253 if (container
== m_container
)
14256 container
= obj
->GetContainer();
14259 if (container
->GetParent())
14261 // If we found that our object's container is within the range of
14262 // a selection higher up, then assume the whole original object
14263 // is also selected.
14264 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* parentContainer
= container
->GetParentContainer();
14265 if (parentContainer
== m_container
)
14267 if (WithinSelection(container
->GetRange().GetStart(), m_ranges
))
14269 wxRichTextRangeArray ranges
;
14270 ranges
.Add(obj
->GetRange());
14275 container
= parentContainer
;
14284 return wxRichTextRangeArray();
14287 // Is the given position within the selection?
14288 bool wxRichTextSelection::WithinSelection(long pos
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
14294 wxRichTextRangeArray selectionRanges
= GetSelectionForObject(obj
);
14295 return WithinSelection(pos
, selectionRanges
);
14299 // Is the given position within the selection range?
14300 bool wxRichTextSelection::WithinSelection(long pos
, const wxRichTextRangeArray
& ranges
)
14303 for (i
= 0; i
< ranges
.GetCount(); i
++)
14305 const wxRichTextRange
& range
= ranges
[i
];
14306 if (pos
>= range
.GetStart() && pos
<= range
.GetEnd())
14312 // Is the given range completely within the selection range?
14313 bool wxRichTextSelection::WithinSelection(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextRangeArray
& ranges
)
14316 for (i
= 0; i
< ranges
.GetCount(); i
++)
14318 const wxRichTextRange
& eachRange
= ranges
[i
];
14319 if (range
.IsWithin(eachRange
))
14325 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextDrawingHandler
, wxObject
)
14326 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextDrawingContext
, wxObject
)
14328 wxRichTextDrawingContext::wxRichTextDrawingContext(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
14332 if (m_buffer
&& m_buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl())
14333 EnableVirtualAttributes(m_buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetVirtualAttributesEnabled());
14336 bool wxRichTextDrawingContext::HasVirtualAttributes(wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
14338 if (!GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
14341 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_buffer
->GetDrawingHandlers().GetFirst();
14344 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14345 if (handler
->HasVirtualAttributes(obj
))
14348 node
= node
->GetNext();
14353 wxRichTextAttr
wxRichTextDrawingContext::GetVirtualAttributes(wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
14355 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
14356 if (!GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
14359 // We apply all handlers, so we can may combine several different attributes
14360 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_buffer
->GetDrawingHandlers().GetFirst();
14363 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14364 if (handler
->HasVirtualAttributes(obj
))
14366 bool success
= handler
->GetVirtualAttributes(attr
, obj
);
14368 wxUnusedVar(success
);
14371 node
= node
->GetNext();
14376 bool wxRichTextDrawingContext::ApplyVirtualAttributes(wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
14378 if (!GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
14381 if (HasVirtualAttributes(obj
))
14383 wxRichTextAttr
a(GetVirtualAttributes(obj
));
14391 int wxRichTextDrawingContext::GetVirtualSubobjectAttributesCount(wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
14393 if (!GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
14396 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_buffer
->GetDrawingHandlers().GetFirst();
14399 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14400 int count
= handler
->GetVirtualSubobjectAttributesCount(obj
);
14404 node
= node
->GetNext();
14409 int wxRichTextDrawingContext::GetVirtualSubobjectAttributes(wxRichTextObject
* obj
, wxArrayInt
& positions
, wxRichTextAttrArray
& attributes
) const
14411 if (!GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
14414 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_buffer
->GetDrawingHandlers().GetFirst();
14417 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14418 if (handler
->GetVirtualSubobjectAttributes(obj
, positions
, attributes
))
14419 return positions
.GetCount();
14421 node
= node
->GetNext();
14426 bool wxRichTextDrawingContext::HasVirtualText(const wxRichTextPlainText
* obj
) const
14428 if (!GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
14431 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_buffer
->GetDrawingHandlers().GetFirst();
14434 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14435 if (handler
->HasVirtualText(obj
))
14438 node
= node
->GetNext();
14443 bool wxRichTextDrawingContext::GetVirtualText(const wxRichTextPlainText
* obj
, wxString
& text
) const
14445 if (!GetVirtualAttributesEnabled())
14448 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_buffer
->GetDrawingHandlers().GetFirst();
14451 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14452 if (handler
->GetVirtualText(obj
, text
))
14455 node
= node
->GetNext();
14460 /// Adds a handler to the end
14461 void wxRichTextBuffer::AddDrawingHandler(wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
)
14463 sm_drawingHandlers
.Append(handler
);
14466 /// Inserts a handler at the front
14467 void wxRichTextBuffer::InsertDrawingHandler(wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
)
14469 sm_drawingHandlers
.Insert( handler
);
14472 /// Removes a handler
14473 bool wxRichTextBuffer::RemoveDrawingHandler(const wxString
& name
)
14475 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= FindDrawingHandler(name
);
14478 sm_drawingHandlers
.DeleteObject(handler
);
14486 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
* wxRichTextBuffer::FindDrawingHandler(const wxString
& name
)
14488 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_drawingHandlers
.GetFirst();
14491 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14492 if (handler
->GetName().Lower() == name
.Lower()) return handler
;
14494 node
= node
->GetNext();
14499 void wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpDrawingHandlers()
14501 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_drawingHandlers
.GetFirst();
14504 wxRichTextDrawingHandler
* handler
= (wxRichTextDrawingHandler
*)node
->GetData();
14505 wxList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
14510 sm_drawingHandlers
.Clear();
14513 void wxRichTextBuffer::AddFieldType(wxRichTextFieldType
*fieldType
)
14515 sm_fieldTypes
[fieldType
->GetName()] = fieldType
;
14518 bool wxRichTextBuffer::RemoveFieldType(const wxString
& name
)
14520 wxRichTextFieldTypeHashMap::iterator it
= sm_fieldTypes
.find(name
);
14521 if (it
== sm_fieldTypes
.end())
14525 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= it
->second
;
14526 sm_fieldTypes
.erase(it
);
14532 wxRichTextFieldType
*wxRichTextBuffer::FindFieldType(const wxString
& name
)
14534 wxRichTextFieldTypeHashMap::iterator it
= sm_fieldTypes
.find(name
);
14535 if (it
== sm_fieldTypes
.end())
14541 void wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpFieldTypes()
14543 wxRichTextFieldTypeHashMap::iterator it
;
14544 for( it
= sm_fieldTypes
.begin(); it
!= sm_fieldTypes
.end(); ++it
)
14546 wxRichTextFieldType
* fieldType
= it
->second
;
14550 sm_fieldTypes
.clear();